Eurocopter AS350B2 RFM Rev - 06 2002
Eurocopter AS350B2 RFM Rev - 06 2002
Eurocopter AS350B2 RFM Rev - 06 2002
'8 eurocopter
8
AS
350
82
REGISTRATION
APPROVED
No
SERIAL
(j ::;;~~I~~~~
~~
BY:
The DIRECTldN
G~NI::RALI:: p~
L'AVIATION CIVIL~ ( DGAC )
Date of approval:
No
Dec&mber
;
.
05. 1990
"ThIs Aotorcraft Flight Manual is the translation of an approved French fright manu~l.
The note "DGAC approved" on ell pages means that these pages are an Integral
r.ranslstion 01 the French Issue approved by DGAC".
This RFM Is approvad for Canadian re~tered
marked "PGAC approved" and coded!!
of all peges
IMPO~TANTNOTE
The pratlca./ velue of this menus) depellds entirely upon-Its being correctly IIp..dated.
The re"'510ns ere recorded on the les!. pogo 01 the rnallUQI..
effectivity of the manual at the lattst rsvlslon Is specified Oil psges O.C.PS.
,A
...The
Thla manual
support8
-*
tlte hellcapter8
delivered
by bo'h
-~::=:
=-n/l
~?===="jrJ::
SHALL ~E CARRIED
EUFlOCOPTER
uslllg th.
AT AI-I. TIMES
EtabllsB8ment
de Msrlgnane
DGACApproved
FRANCE
IN AIRCRAFT
FRANCE
AerospoT./elf1
360 62
O.O.PI
~
~c
90-37
"r
Page
I
w03"
.
,
FI.IGHT HANUAL
C!,!STOMIZAT1.0N.
A/C ,
-SIN,
~TQF ADDITIONAL
APPROVED
PAG~
SECTION
PAGE
DATE CODE
SECTION
PAGE
DATE CODE
THIS AI~CRAFTDOESNOTOFFERANYPARTJ.CULAR
FEATURES
RJ:QIJIRING
THEQJSTOMIZAT1.0N
OF THE FL1.GHT
MANUAL
ON
GREENPAGES.
18
I-ISTOFn LATr:ST
~
NORMAl
REVISION,0
APPROVED
REVISIONS
No
Date
No
(X;AC PPPRO'JFJ)
Date
DAn:
89-17
~..",,411[) DGACApproved.
350 82
[).().~
89-17
P~
FLIGHT MANUAL
.PART
.
.
GENERAL
EMERGENCY
LIMITATIONS
PROCEDURES
NORMAL
PROCEDURES
PERFORMANCE
OGACApproved: SUPPLEMENTS
350 B2
O.O.P2
89-17
Page1
FUGHT
MANUAL
C(J,!POSmON
OF COODmONAl REVISIONS (RC)
~
IF A NORMAL REVISION (RN) MODIFIES 1HE PAGE NUMBER FOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNEDBElCNI, 1HE READERWIll HAVE TO CHANGE1HE NUI.!BEROF 1HE PINK
PAGE BY HAND, SO THAT 1HE INFORMATIOOREMAINS IN ACCORDANCE
WITH 1HE
PARAGRAPHCONCERNED.
Section
Page
Date
RC.A
is ~t
(and further
-revisions)
0.OP3 Page 1 ~B2~ 90-29
AEROSPATIAlE Service
Telex
revisions)
2.1
3.1
: This Conditional
to the manuals
Nomal
Revision
O.
RC.B
-Modification
ams 072596
: ~roved
engine
fire
RC.C
-Modification
AMS 07259B
Supersedes RC.B
DGACApproved:
W
detection
system.
tWO figures
year.
of the year
350 B2
O.O.P3
92-39
Page 1
~B2'
.._I~
FLIGHT MANUAL
0 ~ ~ I <:-c:...
COMPOSITION
.OF
No.RR
SECTION
PAGE
DATE
CODE
No.RR
SECTION
PAGE
DATE
CODE
2A
2.1
7 "62"
91-17
2J
4.1
4.1
13 "RR"
15 "RR"
97-11
97-11
2K
4.1
4.1
4.1
4.1
12 "RR"
13 "RR"
14 *RR"
15 "RR"
97-42
97-42
97-42
97-42
2L
4.1
15 *RR"
99-17
2M
4.1
15 "RR"
00-12
2N
RESERVED
20
4.1
15 "RR"
00-41
0.0.P4
1 "RR"
00-48
3.1
4 "RR"
00-48
Supersedes RR 2A
26
2.1
7 "62"
91-29
2C
2.1
3.3
4.1
4.1
4.1
6 "62"
5 "62"
6 "62"
11 "82"
16 "82"
92-33
92-33
92-33
92-33
92-33
20
2.1
3 "82"
92-42
Supersedes RR 2D
2E
2.1
3 "82"
93-19
Supersedes RR 2L
2F
4.1
12 "82"
93-50
2P
.2G
4.1
8 "82"
94-05
2H
4.1
4.1
12 "RR"
14 "RR"
94-08
94-08
21
3.3
5 "RR"
96-03
DGAC Approved :
IAI
ICIDIEIFIGIHI
(~~~:)
0 .0 .P 4
00-48
Page 1
"RR"
._-"_.~,.-
,"""".
..
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
.(1)
PageRevision Code
-R
-N
: Revised,
: New, to
SECTION
O.
O.
O.
O.
O.
O.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
7.
7.
7.
7.
7.
7.
7.
7.
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
2
3
to be replaced
be inserted
PAGE
P1
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P6
1
3
1
1
1
1/03
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
1
1
2
3.
4
1
1
1
DATE
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
89-17
02-03
99-38
89-17
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
92-12
92-12.
99-38
(1)
SECTION
7. 3
7. 3
7. 3
7. 4
7. 4
7. 5
7. 5
7. 5
7. 5
7. 5
7. 6
7. 6
7. 7
7. 7
7. 7
7. 8
7. 8
7. 8
7. 8
7. 9
7.10
7.10
7.11
7.11
7.11
8. 0
8. 1
8. 1
8. 2
PAGE
P6
DATE (1)
2
3
4
1
2
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
1
2
3
1
2
3
4
1
1
2
1
2
3
1
1
2
1
89-17
89-17
99-38
89-17
99-38
89-17
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
89-17
92-12
99-38
89-17
89-17
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
89-17
99-38
35082
O.O.P5
02-03
Page 1
-
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
SECTION
8. 2
8. 2
8. 2
8. 2
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8.3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 3
8. 4
8. 4
8.
PAGE
2
3
4
5
1
2.
3
4
5
6
7
8
8 M
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
1
2
DATE (1)
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
SECTION
8.4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
9. 0
9. 1
9. 1
9. 1
9. 2
9. 2
9, 2
9. 2
9. 2
9. 2
9. 3
9. 4
9. 4
9. 4
9. 5
9. 6
9. 7
9. 7
9. 8
9. 8
9. 8
P6
PAGE
DATE (1)
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
1
1
2
3
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
1
2
3
1
1
1
2
1
2
3
99-38
02-03
99-38
99-38
99-38
02-03
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
02-03
89-17
89-17
89-17
02-03
99-48
02-03
02-03
02-03
02-03
89-17
99-38
89-17
89-17
89-17
99-38
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
99-38
9.
99-38
8. 4
8. 4
4
5
99-38
99-38
9.10
9.10
1
2
99-38
99-38
350 82
R
~
R
N
N
N
N
O.O.P5
02-03
Page 2
SECTION
.
.
.
9.11
9.11
9.11
9.11
9.11
9.12
9.27
9.27
9.27
9.27
9.27
9.27
9.27
10. 0
10. 2
10. 2
10. 2
10. 2
10. 2
10. 2
10. 2
10. 2
10. 2
10. 2
10. 2
10. 3
10. 4
10. 4
10. 4
10. 4
10. 4
10. 4
10. 4
10.4
PAGE
P6
DATE (1)
1
2
3
4
5
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
1
1
2.
3
4
5
6
7
8
Date
89-17
99-48
92-12
02-03
93-05
93-15
99-38
No
REVISIONS
No
PAGE
DATE (1)
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
92-12
93-05
99-48
99-48
99-48
99-48
99-48
99-48
99-48
99-38
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
SECTION
REVISION
NORMALE:
Date
350 82
O.O.P5
02-03
--
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAl.
COMPOSITION
OF CONDITIONALREVISIONS (RC)
PARAGRAPH
CC>NCERNEP.
Section
Page
Dete
Applfceble
before
cond1tfon
1s met I
aDGAC Approved,
350B2
two figures
hea~.
O.O.P3
89-17
---~.c,..
-~
Page1
"
:=
r'-"'"'In'
SECTION
PAGE
4.
4.
4.
5.
5.
5.
5.
5.
5.
5.
5.
5.
5.
5.
5.
5.
1
2
3
1
J.
2
3
4
5
6
7
B
9
10
J.1
J.2
2
2
2
0
1
1
J.
J.
].
1
1
1
1
1
1
J.
PATE (1)
90-37
89-17
90-37
90-37
90-37
89-17
89-17
89-J.7
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
90-37
SECTION
PAGE
"""'U1\L
DATE (1)
R
R
R
R
8
LIST OF THE I.ATESTNORMAL
APPROVEDREVISIONS
No
Date
89-17
90-37
No
NORMALREVISION: 1
DGACAPPROVED
DATE.
-.. 09
Date
PGAC
Approved:
350~2
r-r-1
().().~!5
90-37
Page 2
co)"
FLIGHT MANUAL
.SECTION
~
CONTENTS
Page
1.1
PELIMINARYNOTES
1.2
UPDATING
1.3
SYMBOLS
.
.
OGAC
Approved.
[g
350 B2
1.0.P
89-17
Page 1
FLIGHTMANUAL
.SECTION
1
1 PRELIMINARY
NOTES
1.1
GENERAL
To achieve the required degree of safety, this manual must be used in
conjunction with the relevant regulations covering aircraft
operation,
such as aerial navigation laws in the operator's country. It is essential
for the crew to become f~iliar
with the contents of this manual, special
certification
requirements and any information specific to custcxnized
configurations,
and to check all revisions and related requirements.
1.2
DESCRIPTION
OF MANUAL
This manual contains legally approved information, together with additional manufacturer's
information not subject to approval; the entire
manual ccxnplies with the reccmnendations of the Helicopter Association
International
(HAl).
-The approved information is contained in PART1 -FLIGHT MANUAL-,
in sections 1,2,3,4,5 and in the Supplements.
-The information not subject to Approval is contained in PART2
-COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL-,as a Supplement to PART1.
This information is covered by sections 6,7,8,9 and 10. Each PARTof
Manual makes up a whole and, for this reason, incorporates its own
List of Pages and is revised separately.
1.2.1
Basic Aircraft
The basic helicopter
1.2.2
specifications
1 through 10.
1.3
ADAPTATION
OF MANUALTO CERTIFICATIONREQUIREMENTS
Specific certification
.DGAC
Approved:
~
350 82
Jl.()
89-17
---
Page1
--
FLIGHT MANUAL
1.4 CUSTOMIZATION
MODIFICATIONS
(printed
ongreen
paper)
of green pages.
.
DGAC
Approved:
[]
350B2
89-17
1l. ()
Page2
~
~
,
,
FLIGHTMANUAL
.A
J~
2 UPDATING
2.1-~~
This Manual is updated
revisions
(RN).
2.2
periodically
through
rush
revisions
(RR) or
normal
REVISIONS
Aerospatiale
makes every effort
to keep this manual updated by revisions
to complete the user's information
and capabilities.
Each revision is
accompanied by instructions
sunmarizing the major points affected by the
change and advising the person responsible for incorporating
the revised
pages in the manual. (The instruction
sheet can be filed separately from
the manual).
The user is responsible for ensuring proper updating of the manual
complying with the List of Pages given at the beginning of PART1, PART2
and of each supplement, since each of the these PARTSor Supplements is
revised separately.
R
R
The date code is composed of the last two digits of the year, followed
by the number of the week in that year.
The variant code includes two digits
placed under the page number for
identification
of the version, certification
or related customization.
2.2.1
Normal revisi~
(printed
on white paper)
Rush revisions
(printed
on yellow
paper)
list
CO.0.P4, page 1)
.DGAC
Approved:
W
350 82
1.()
90-37
to",..
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
2.2.3
a.
.
DGAC
Approved:
W
35082
1.() ~
89-17
Page 4,
FLIGHT MANUAl
.3
SYMBOLS
& ABBREVIATIONS
SYMBOLS
French
~:
English
--
-Rate of climb
-Indicated
airspeed
-True airspeed
-Calibrated
airspeed
-Optimum climbing speed
-Takeoff
safety speed
-Critical
decision speed
-Never exceed speed
-Wind velocity
~
R/C
I.A.S.
T.A.S.
C.A.S.
Vy
V. TOSS
Vl
VNE
Vw
Vz
Vi
Vp
Vc
Vy
VSD
Vl
VNE
Vw
Altitudes:
-Take-off
-Critical
-Pressure
-Density
or landing height
decision height
altitude
altitude
h
hl
Hp
Ho
h
hl
Zp
ZcI"
~:
-Weight
-Maximum take-off
weight
-Empty weight
-Equipped empty weight
-Operating
empty weight
-All-up
weight
Wt
M. TOW
E.W
E.E.W.
E.O.W.
A.U.W.
M
m
M.V.
M.V.E.
M.O.E.
M.T.
Temperature,
-Outside
air temperature.
e s
Miscellaneous:
= ~~~~~e-========================================= ~
-Barometric
pressure, in millibars
Po
-Degrees centigrade
C
-Rotor
speed
NR
-Gas generator speed
Ng
-Free turbine speed
Nf
-Exhaust Gas Temperature (E.G.T.)
t4
-Out of ground effect
D.G.E.
-In ground effect
I.G.E.
-Main gear box
M.G.B.
-Tail
gear box
T.G.B.
.DGAC
Approved,
~
~
Po
"C
NR
Ng
NTL
t4
H.E.S.
D.E.S.
B. T .P.
B.T .A.
350B2
jl. ()
89-17
-I
Page5
1
FLIGHTMANUAL
.SECTION
2
LIMITATIONS
CONTENTS
Pages
2.1
OPERATING
LIMITATIONS
1
APPLICABILITY
TYPESOF OPERATION
APPROVED
BASIS OF CERTIFICATION
'
WEIGHT
LIMITS
"I
CENTRE-Of-GRAVITY
LIMITS
MAXIMUM
SPEED
APPROVED
FLIGHT ENVELOPE
MAIN ROTORSPEED
ROTORBRAKELIMITATION
TORQUE
LIMITATIONS
10
,e
2.2
-~
11
ENGINELIMITATIONS
12
LUBRICATIONSYSTEMLIMITATIONS
13
ELECTRICALANDHYDRAULIC
POWER
SYSTEMLIMITATIONS --7
14
LANDINGANDSTOPPINGLIMITATIONSON SLOPES
15
RESTRICTIONS
16
MINIMUN CREW
17
TRANSPORT
OF PERSONNEL
18
LIFED COMPONENTS
PLACARDS
AND INSTRUMENT
MARKINGS
1
PLACARDS
INSTRUMENT
MARKINGS
DGAC
Approved:
i~
350 B2
2.0.P
89-17
Page1
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION2.1
OPERA~~-~~TIONS
1
APPLICABILITY
THE LIMITATIONS SPECIFIED IN THIS SECTIONAREMANDATORY.
They cover the basic aircraft
version.
Any additional
restrictions
resulting
from installation
of optional
equipment items are specified
in the relevant SUPPLEMENTS.
TYPESOF OPERATIONAPPROVED
Operating the helicopter
-Day VFR flight
-Night
VFR flight,
when the
serviceable,
provided
such
regulations
3
conditions,
for:
equipment
items are jnstalled
is permitted
by the flight
and
concerned.
BASIS OF CERTIFICATION
The helicopter
of the country
required
operation
WEIGHTLIMITS
-Maximum permissible
weight:
2250 kg
(4961lb)
.
.DGAC
Approved:
W
350 B2
2.1
89-17
Page 1!I
FLIGHT MANUAL
5 CENTRE
OFGRAVIlY
LIMITS
5.1
Longitudinal
C.C!.
The c.g. datum is located -3.40 m (133.8 in) forward of the main rotor
head centre line.
The longitudinal
c.g. limits
are given by the graph below:
3.
3.25
:
CENTRAGE
3.30
3.35
( m)
3.40
2400 ~:~~:~:~:~:::::
:~::~::;~:: :~:~;~~:~::::::
~::.:~:;~:
::~:::::::: ::: :~;;~;~:~~:~:~:~:
::~:~::~;~;~:;~
;~:~;:~:~
:::
~
i
...0 000000
18001;,~;1
:::::000
5500
0..'.0.0.0000'0'0..0.0000.
0.00::
;;;::~~;
.;~.:o
:,0:
i
~ 1750:;:;:
1600:.:00:
00..
~
1400...,0.
GO
~ci
LIMITE
ARRIERE
REARWARD
LIMIT
:;::::;:; 3858
',:.:': 3500
0..
:::;:: 3000
0.0.
IT
i
5.2
Lateral
-L.H.
c.o.
limit:
0,18
-R.H.
limit:
The datum is the aircraft
m (7.08
0.14 m (5.51
in)
in)
symmetry plane.
6 MAXIMUM
SPEED
6.1
6.1.1
6.1.2
VNE with
doors closed
VNE Power-on
-Absolute
VNE is 155 knots (287 km/hr -178 MPH) at zero pressurealtitude.
-At
higher altitudes
this speed is to be reduced by 3 knots (5,5 km/hr
or 3,5 MPH) per 1000 ft and 18 km/hr per 1000 m,
VNE values versus altitudes
are marked on the airspeed indicator,
-In
cold weather the following must be subtracted from VNE:
10 knots (19 km/hr -12 MPH) when O.A.To is below -30. C.
VNE Power-off
-Absolute
VNE is 125 knots (231 km/hr -144 MPH) at zero pressurealtitude.
-At
higher altitudes
this speed is to be reduced by 3 knots (5,5 km/hr
-3,5 MPH) per 1000 ft or 18 km/hr per 1000 m.
-In
cold weather, reduce the VNE as follows:
20 knots (37 km/hr, 23 MPH) when O.A.T. is below -20.C without
dropping below 65 knots (120 km/hr, 75 MPH).
I
2.1.
R
DGAC
Approved:
350
82
-=
Page
2
--,.'--
FLlGiT MANUAL
tj
I
I
I RR2E I
I
I
RR2E SupersedesRR20
Fliqht
in fallino
-Flight
flight
snow
when viSibility
in falling
is greater
""
snow is authorized.
refer to Supp. 4.
.
,
..".
Ix;A.CApproved
---IAIBICIOIEIFIGIHI
35082
93-19
2.1
Page 3
*B2*
FLIGHT MANUAL
6.2VNE
withdoors
removed
VNE is limited
to 70 knots
permissible
configurations:
.4
~~
doors removed
2 R.H. doors removed
.2 L.H.
doors removed
(130
km/hr
-Any
-B1
other
MPH) for
configuration
is
prohibited
7.1
Altitude
Maximum substantiated
7.2
pressure-altitude,
20000 ft
(6096
m)
Temperature
"-
~::=-:emperature
40 *C
For temperatures
in Cold Weather-Maximum
7.3
lower than
(SUP.4)
-25*C,
refer
to -Instructions
temperature
Manoeuvring
Do not
for
Operation
to
+50*C
limitations
exceed
reversibility
8
the following
the
load factor
corresponding
to the servocontrol
limit.
MAIN ROTORSPEED
8.1
Power on
.On
the
.In
stabilized
ground
at
low pitch
380.:.
flight
5 r~
390 + 4 r~
-5
8.2
Power
off
.Maximum
430 r~
320 r~
.~~~n::e-:~~-::~::-::~-:::-~:::~-:::::-~:-~-
-.below
.above
9
DGAC Approved:
[f]
(continuous
( intermittent
sound)
sound).
360 r~
410 r~
rotor
time
application:
brakings
170 r~
5 minutesI
350 B2
~.JlI
89-17
Page 3I
FLIGHT MANUAL
10 TORQUE
LIMITATIONS
When
airspeedis lowerthan 40 kt (74 km/hr) (46 MPH)
:
-Maxim~
-Maxim~
: 107 %
100 %
11 ENGINELIMITATIONS
The aircraft
is equipped with a TURBOMECA
*ARRIEL 101* engine.
Operating limitations
are determined by the free turbine rotation
(Ng), by the exhaust gas temperature (t4) or by the gas generator
speed (Nf) depending on the operating conditions.
speed
rotation
transient
rating
(less
than 5 sec.)
= +6
continuous rating:
-Ng dfff
-Ng diff
= -0.6
= -3.5
: 100%Ngcorresponds
to 51800rpm.
11.2 t4 Tsnperature
-Maxim~
795'C
-Maxim~
-Maxim~
on takeoff
continuous
845'C
795.C
11.3 FreeTurbineSpeed
-Maxim~
continuous
equivalent
417 rpm
330 rpm
463 rpm
DGAC
Approved:
[fJ
350B2
.-
2.1
89-17
Page4
FLIGHT MANUAL
.11.4
~
11.4.1
Standard Fuels
Type of fuel
Kerosene
NATO
symbol
Anti-ice
Additive
-50
Yes
(AVTUR-FSII X JP8)
Kerosene -50
(AVTUR) (JP1)
Kerosene
s
-dash
11.4.2
nlJnber.
Emergency fuels
Type of fuel
NATO
SPECIFICATION
U.
Aviation
Gasoline
F 12
MIL G 5572
-AIR
340180/87
(AVGAS)
0
5
Au omo ive
Gasoline
estrictions
-Within
anyone period between overhauls of the engine. the use of
gasoline is limited to 25 hours maximum.
-Add 2 %of mineral lubricating
oil if possible.
-Hp
up to 1500 ft.
-Fuel
temperature up to 30"C.
: The filter
DGAC Approved:
[I]
indicator.
350 82
~.
89-17
JL
Page 5
FLIGHT MANUAL
11.5
Additives
11.5.1 Anti-Ice
Additive
shall
Additive
0.00017;
by volume.
12 LUBRIFICATIONSYSTEMLIMITATIONS
12.1 Authorized
-Synthetic
oil (3
-Synthetic
oil (3
-Synthetic
oil (5
-Synthetic
oil (5
-Mineral-base
oil
cstJ
cst)
cst)
cst)
.
NATO0 148 or
NATO0 150 or
NATO0 155 or
NATO0 160 or
NATO0155 or
MIL-L-7808
AIR 3514
MIL-L-23599
O.Eng.RD 2797
MIL-L-5085
to procedure defined
overheating
warning light
TYPE
Synthetic
5 CST
NATO
SYMBOL
0155
SP CIFICATION
FRENCH
USA
MI -L
-23699
UK
-
--O.ENG.RO
OTHER
OILS
Temperature
below + 15OC
OGAC
Approved:
2497
--
refer
350B2
to procedure
89-17.
Page
5 ~l
~. Jl
FLIGHT MANUAL
.EJ
Paragraph12.3
USE
NATO CODE
SPECIFICATION
FRENCH
U.S.A.
0156
OTHER
U.K.
MIL L.23699
.
OILS
AUTHORIZED
BUT NOT RECOMMENDED
PROHIBITED ABOVE 15'C
OIL TYPE
NATO CODE
SPECIFICATION
FRENCH
0.148
U.S.A.
U.K.
MIL.L7808
AIR 3514
OTHER
USE PROHIBITED
0
OIL TYPE
NATO CODE
OILS
BELOW -10'C
SPECIFICATION
FRENCH
0. 149
U.S.A.
U.K.
DERD2487
TUR8OMECAdocument.
-In
the event of a change in oil grade or specification,
the oil
system must be flushed as prescribed in TUR80MECA
Maintenance Manual.
).
(
\
DGAC
Approved:
W
350
82
2.1
92-33
-*B2*
Page6
FLIGHT k/..
EJ
~:
1)
RR 2B supersedes RR2A.
For helicopters
subjected to the restrictions
laid down in
Airworthiness
Directive No 91-D95-057B, or in Service Telex
No Ol-32,or in Airworthiness
Directive N 91-156(B), add the
following
to the prohibited manoeuvres of paragraph 15 :
-Intentional
on the instrlanent
panel:
.INTENTIONALENGINESHUTDOWN
IN FLIGHT IS PROHIBITED.
2)
embodiment of
.
DGACApproved
IAI
ICIDIEIFIGIHI
350 B2
2.1
91-29
PAGE 7
FUGIfT MANUAL
15 PROHIBITED
MANOEUVRES
For the helicopters subjected to the restrictions
specified in paragraph A
of Ainworthiness Directive No. 90-105B (and further revisions), or in
AEROPASTIALE
Service Telex No. 0125B (and further revisions), add the
following prohibited manoeuvres:
-Autorotational
-Intentional
I-
-CI
landing training
de-synchronization
DGACApproved:
350 B2
2.1
90-29
Page 7
~B2"
L-
FLIGHT MANUAL
.12.4
~1ne
temperature
temperature before power application
115"C
--O"C
13 ELECTRICALANDHYDRAULIC
POWER
SYSTEMLIMITATIONS
13.1 Hydraulic
.13.1.1
System
~
-Synthetic
-Mineral-base
If the fluid specification
is changed. refer
in the Maintenance Manual.
13.1.2
Hydraulic
System Pressure
In flight
13.2 Electrical
MIL-H-83282 (recoovnended)
MIL-H-5605 (AIR 3520 DTD585 -NATO H 515)
to the procedure specified
must be off.
System
-Maximum voltage
Rated voltage range 25-29 V
-Maximum current
31.5 V
150 A
14 LANDINGANDSTOPPINGLIMITATIONSON SLOPES
-Nose-up
-Nose-down
-Sideways
10'
5'
S'
15 RESTRICTIONS
The following are prohibited:
-Flying
in icing conditions
-Aerobatics
-Engine power reduction in flight
autorotational
traIning.
using fuel
flow control
except for
15 MINIMUMCREW
One pilot.
DGACApproved:
m
in starboard seat.
350 82
2.1
89-17
Page 7
FLIGHT MANUAL
17TRANSPORT
OF
PERSONNEL
NlJI1berof persons carried:
6 maximum(pilot
.
included)
18 LIFED COMPONENTS
Lifed canponents. and the corresponding S.L.L. are indicated in the
Master Servicing Recommendations(P.R.E.).
SECTION
5.99. and must be
replaced in accordance therewith.
.
.
DGAC
Approved:
[]
350
B2
~.1l.
89-17
Page 8
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION
2.2
PLACARDS
AND INSTRUMENT
MARKINGS
1
PLACARDS
1.1 Plates
Displayed
.Operating
in the Cockpit
limitations
8.
Plates
.In
CHARGESREPARTIES
MAXI
DISTRIBUTED
LDAD-iM~;;.
SUR
PlANCHER
CABINE
.In
the L.H.
AR.R'ERE
ON REARCABIN FLOOR
SUR PlANCHER AVANT GAUCHE
ON LH. FORWARDCASIN flOOR
3IQ.g
hold
CHARGE
MAXI.120kg
; MAX.LOAD
2641b
~~~o':D.~~~:;E~OiARGE
REPAAT'E
MAXI
1 DISTRIBUTED
lOAD.MAXI:==
SO..
mu
:6821
ISOIg
J301b
.In
~ CHARGE
MAXI.100k
~ MAX..LOAD
220lbg
1.3 Fuel
Placard
A placard on the instrument panel displays the correspondence between
the fuel contents gauge percentage and the fuel quantity for the
selected units.
DGAC
Approved:
[f]
35082
2.2
89-17
Page 1
-01-
~---
FLIGHTMANUAL
2 INSTRUMENT
MARKINGS
Colour code
-Red
-Red with white hatching
-Yellow
-Green
-White
INSTRUMENTS
: Safety limit
: VNE. power-off
,Caution range
,Normal operating range
,Equipment operating limit.
MARKINGS
AIRSPEEDINDICATOR
( NOTE)
Red
Red
Gree
TORQUE
INDICATOR
Red
Red line
Green arc
Yellow arc
White triangle
Red line
ROTOR
AND
FREE
RANGE
125 kt / 231 km/hr/144 MPH
155 kt / 287 km/hr/178 MPH
from 40 to 155 Kt
74 to 287km/hr-4"6 to 178 MPH
%
100 %
10 -94 %
94 -100 %
170 rpm
320 rpm
Green arc
Yellow arc
375 -394
394 -430
rpm
rpm
Red1ine
430 rpm
Red line
330 rpm
Yellow arc
TURBINE
TACHOMETER
FREE
Green arc
Yellow line
Yellow arc
375 -417
417 rpm
rpm
Red line
Red triangle
+6
EXHAUST
GAS
Greenarc
300 -795"C
TEMPERATURE
(T4)
INDICATOR
Yellow arc
Red line
Red triangle
795 -845"C
845"C
865"C
above-30"C.
DGAC
Approved,
m
350 82
~"~
89-17
Page2
FLIGHTMANUAL
INSTRUMENTS
MARKINGS
ENGINEOIL PRESSURE
Red arc
INDICATOR
Green arc
Yellow arc
ENGINEOIL TEMPERATURE
Green arc
INDICATOR
Red line
Green arc
RANGE
1.3 -1.8 bar
(18.9 -25.1 p.s.i.J
1.8 -5
bar
(26.1 -72.5 p.s.i.J
above 5 bar (72.5 p.s.i.J
30 -115'C
115'C
Yellow arc
VOLTMETER
Green arc
Yellow arc
Red line
26 -29 Volts
29 -31.5 Volts
31.5 Volts
AMMETER
Red line
150 A.
FUELPRESS. INDICATOR
.
.
DGAC
Approved:
m
350 B2
~.~
89-17
Page3
-01-
--
I
FLIGHT MANUAL
.SECTION
3
EMERGENCYPROCEDURES
CONTENTS
3.1
INTRODUCTION
AUTOROTATION
LANDING
ENGINEFAILURES
GOVERNOR
FAILURES
ENGINEFIRE
.5
3.2
Pages
EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
SMOKEIN THE~""..~~.~
TAIL ROTORFAILURE
4
4
SYSTEMFAILURES
1
ENGINESYSTEMFAILURES
Ng diff-
HYDRAULIC
SYSTEMFAILURES
BLEEDVALVEFLAGON Ng INDICATOR
TORQLE-t4-NRINOlCATORFAILURES
3.3 WARNING-CAUTION-AOVlSORY
PANELANDAURALWARNING
C!D
AURALWARNING
WARNING-CAUTION-ADVlSORY
PANEL
DGACApproved:
[fJ
350 B2
~.().f1
89-17
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
.SECTION
3.1
EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
1
INTRODUCTION
The procedures
outlined
in this
section
deal with the common types of
anergencies
; however,
the actions
taken in each actual
emergency must
relate
to the canp1ete situation.
Throughout
this section,
-land
immediately-,-land
as soon as possibleand -land as soon as practicab1eare used to reflect
the degree of
urgency and are to be interpreted
as follows:
-land
(or ditch)
Immediately
-land
as soon as possible:
land at the nearest site
at which a safe
landing
can be made
-land
as soon as practicable:
extended flight
is not reconwnended. The
landing
site and duration
of the flight
are at the discretl6n
of the
pilot.
.
2
2.1
AUTOROTATIONlANDING
Autorotation
landing
Procedure
following
Engine
Failure
-Set
low collective
pitch.
-Monitor
and control
rotor
r.p.m.
-Establish
approximately
65 knots (120 km/hr) airspeed.
-Move the fuel
flow control
to the shutdown position.
-According
to the cause of loss of the engine:
.Re-light
the engine (see paragraph 3.2 of this
Section).
.Otherwise
: close the fuel shut-off
valve
switch off:
the booster
punp
generator
alternator
(if
installed)
electrical
power master -AlL-OFF-
(if
switch
smell of burning).
NOTE:
2.2
landing
-Do not
-Control
-Cushion
-Reduce
.DGAC
after
Approved:
m
Engine
Failure
in Hover I.G.E.
reduce collective
pitch.
yaw.
touch-down
by increasing
collective
pitch.
collective
pitch as soon as the aircraft
is
on the ground.
350 B2
~.jl
89-17
Page1
".I~.
~IIIIIIII..FL
IGHT
MANUAL
2.3Landing
afterEngine
Failure
inHover
C.G.E.
Autorotation
Landing Training
Procedure
-Reduce collective
pitch to establish autorotation configuratIon.
-Monitor
and control rotor r.p.m.
-During final approach, shut down the engine, or reduce power,
maintaining the Ng above 67 X.
-After
touch-down, still
at low collective
pItch, apply the normal
start
ingprocedure.
3 ENGINE
FAILURE
3.1Flame-out
inFlIght
are as follows:
in high-power flight).
.Drop
inrotorspeed
(aural
warning
sounds
below
360
r~).
.Torque at zero.
.Ng falling
off to zero:
.Generator warning light illumInates.
.Engine oil pressure drop warning light illuminates.
In the event of an engine failure
in flight,
carry out autorotation
transition
procedure (see paragraph 2).
3.2
RelIghting
but,
relighting
may be
below:
pumps -on
-Generator
-on
-Wait until Ng falls below 30 X then
procedure.
DGAC
Approved:
m
350
B2
~.1l .
89-17 Page
2
FLIQiT
MAN
G
2.4
AUTOROTATIONAL
LANOING
1RAININGPROCEDURE
For the helicopters
specified
in paragraph A
of Ai !"WOrthiness Di rective
No. 90-1058 (and further
revisions),
AEROPASTIALE Service Telex No. 01258 (and further
revisions),
autorotational
-Reduce
-Monitor
-shut
landing training
collective
and
pitch
control
to
rotor
-After
landing,
engine stops.
with
procedure is as follows :~
establish
r.p.m.
auto
then,
rotational
without
DGAC
Approved:
configuration.
delay,
the collective
lever
in
low position,
t;)
or in
the
wait
until
the
procedure.
350 82
3. 1
90-29
Page2
"B2"
FLIGHT MANUAL
.4
GOVERNOR
FAILURE
4.1
j
i
4.2
4.3~
Surging is evidenced by hunting of the r.p.m., torque and t4 indications
and jerks in the yaw axis.
.Change the collective
pitch setting.
If surging persists while fuel pressure and engine oil pressure are
correct, reduce fuel flow slightly
to leave the governed range.
If surging still
persists,
land as soon as possible and shut down
the engine if there is a tendency to divergence (see paragraph 2.1).
.
5
5.1
ENGINEFIRE
Fire during Engine Start
-Close the fuel shut-off
cock and apply the rotor brake if necessary.
-Switch off the booster pumps.
-Crank the engine for 10 seconds then switch off the battery.
-Use the nearby extinguishers to fight the fire.
~
..,
DGAC
Approved:
m
350B2
89-17
3.1
Page
3
FLIGHT MANUAL
-Enter autorotation
(seeparagraph
2.1).
-Close
-Switch
the fuel
off the
shut-off
booster
(if installed).
-Switch
off
of burning.
the
electrical
master
if
there
is a smell
6.1
If
Source
of Smoke is
-Shut
off the
-If
necessary,
identified --
corresponding
use the fire
system.
extinguisher-.
6.2
The
.The
front
ventilator
ventilation
ports
.The
bad weather
If
source
windows.
of Smoke is
not
identified
-Shut
off the heating -demisting
system.
If the smoke does not clear:
-Switch
off the electrical
master switch (*ALL OFF-).
-When the smell of smoke has cleared,
set all switches
to *OFF*,
including
the generator
and alternator
(if
installed),
close the
cabin ventilators.
-Reset
the *ALL OFF- electrical
master switch to normal position.
-Switch
on the generator,
check voltage
and current.
-If
everything
is normal,
switch
on the circuits
one by one until
the
malfunction
is identified.
NOTE,
If
the
electrical
-appropriate
7
power
procedure,
supply
system
as detailed
is
faulty,
in Section
carry
out
the
3.3.
7.1
Tail
Rotor
Drive
Failure
Failure
of
the
Tail
Rotor
in Hover
or
at
depend
occurs.
on the
power
and
~---
Low Speed
-I.G.E.
: bring the aircraft
to the ground by reducing
collective
pitch before
the yaw rate
is too high.
-O.G.E.
: reduce collective
pitch
moderately,
to reduce yaw torque,
and simultaneously
start
to pick up speed.
.If
installed
DGAC
Approved:
crJ
350B2
~.Jl
89-17
Page4
~-
~:
FLIGHT MANUAL
.B
Add the following text to paragraph "7 TAIL ROTOR FAILURE" :
CAUTION:
-8
.
.
DGAC Approved
IAI
ICIDIEIFIGIHI
350 B2
3 .1
00-48
Page 4
RR"
FLIGHT MANUAL
.7.1.2
Failurein Forward
Flight
-In forward flight
reduce the power as much as possible and maintain
forward speed (weathercock effect),
select a suitable landing area
for a steep approach at a power enabling a reasonably coordinated
flight.
-On final approach, shut down the engine and make an autorotative
landing at the lowest possible speed.
7.2
.
J
DGAC
Approved:
350 B2
3.1
89-17
Page5
---=~
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION3.2
~TEM
FAIL~ES
FUEL SYSTEMFAILURES
1.1
No fuel pressure
Failure is confirmed by i11unination
Section 3.3 para. 2.2.
If failure
is not confirmed.
Flight may be continued.
1.2
Low fuel
~
'\:J1
the faulty
See
pressure
Failureis co--:;;rmed
by i11unination
of theF.FILT.warn1ng.1ight.
See
Section3.3para.2.2.
If failure is not confirmed.
Flight may be continued.
2
the faulty
ENGINESYSTEMFAILURES
2.1
Warning-Caution-Adv1sory
Ng above 85 %*
i11uninates.
.Light
If torquemeter reading
autorotation
whef)tested:
landing.
'.
If torquemeter reading
Monitor ENG. P. light.
DGAC
Approved:
'J
is correct.
35082
3.2
Page
1
FLIGHT MANUAL
2.2
2.2.1
2.2.2
In Cruising
Flight
Reduce
power; then proceedas prescribedabove.
3
3.1
Ng DIFF.,
Ng difference
Indicator
.,
Failure
limits:
O.A.T.
t4limit
Below15-C
Above15-C
3.2
730-C
750.C
Torquemeter Failure
In the event of a torquemeter failure,
rise above following Ng limits:
Zp(ft)
8000
6000
96
97
94
95
96
97
NG -98
4000
92
93
94
95
96
96
90
91
92
93
94
95
2000
-35
-25 -15
-5
1 (-C)
t4 Indicator
Failure
DGAC
Approved:
m
to *LIMITATIONS* section).
350B2
3.2
89-17
Page2.
---
FLIGHT MANUAL
.3.4
AbnormalNR/NfReadings
3.4.1
3.4.2
Different
NR/Nf readings
"'
3.5
Rotor RPMIndicator
Failure
Failure
HYDRAULIC
SYSTEM
FAILURES
4.1
4.2
Yaw Servo-control
-In
hover
-In
cruisIng
Slide-valve
flight:
Main Servo-control
Seizure
Seizure
-Actuate
the switch, situated on the collective
pitch control lever,
to cut off hydraulic pressure.
Load feedback will be felt immediately;
load feedback may be heavy
if the helicopter
is flying at high speed:
collective
pitch:
20 kg pitch increase load
.cyclic
: 7 to 4 kg left-hand cyclic load
.cyclic:
2 to 4 kg forward cyclic load
.yaw pedals:
practically
no load in cruising flight.
.DGAC
Approved:
m
--.J
of the NHYDNlight.
350 82
3.2
89-17
Page3
FLIGHT MANUAL
BLEED
VALVEFLAGONNg DIFFERENCE
INDICATOR
.I
.
DGAC
Approved:
~
350B2
~.~
B9-17
Page4
4IIJ
FLIGHT MANUAL
SEmON 3.3
WARNING-CAUTION-AD~~~~L
1
AND AURALWARNING
AURALWARNING
The horn sounds to warn of :
-Rotor
speed (NR) between approx. 250 and 360 r.p.m.
-Rotor
speed above 410 r.p.m. (intermittent
sound).
-Hydraulic
pressure drop (below 30 bars).
(continuous
sound).
-If
-If
procedure
(if
sounds)
of
fmN CIPTIOO
LffiICS
__IN-'~UM
,
, ,.1
0
""1--
00.
~
Ie 410
--n
:;~:::,:,~:.:;,:,::::='
rJl'TIDI""",lIMOJT
I
I ,
CAPTImI
LIOIT
= mIT
'S "laG nMN
JO
HYD
-_00 0
p<
'~
P>3Oboo
UQlT Tro.CUT
.,.
I
nDi
""1-
s:
8
i
DGAC
APproved:
W
I(RII
a]
NJTE
Do
... t
..
~
~
.~.
""'.':
..~.
=
-DE L!!!!!JCAPT""
L'GHT
ODES
...
~_OHI_,","~8ARS,
mADr LmlT -III
250...~"__360,."
.FLA9111G
LDoT
,360...
we,
IS EnIB
..'"
.-.
ET-.
UM
00.
HYD
~
~
~
I
Ie 4tO
--.DE
I
I
CAPTlOO
iURjuarr
IlIT
-P<OOb..
0
HORN
is pushed in.
soeed, the HORNlight
[E!PJ
CAPTIDI
u...TmE9
mIT
--'SHDJ&_JO-
P>3Oboo
.IIJ1[
CN'T'Qo0i!!1J
LIIJITCIIT
.n
--DOGS
WtH ,
ttJFEUn1~~ !ftDPLm-JO_DIIIMDS_'
n_v
If! EnEENzo , ,..
AI()360
.{CGlTDOAS
-.
If! HlGP ,
y-
'.-'TTo.T
4'0...
~,
350 82
:3.:3
90-37
Page1
FLIGHT MANUAL
WARNING-CAUTION-ADVISORY
PANEL
The Warning-Caution-Advisory
lights of different
colours:
Panel located
on the instrument
panel includes
Red LiQhts
Light
Failure
Pilot
Servo-control
system failure.
The pressure stored in the
accumulators allows sufficient
time to reach the fall-back
speed with hydraulic
servoassistance.
HYD
I Warning
action
-In
flight:
.Calmy reduce collective
pitch and qjust the airspeed to between 40 and
60 knots (74 to ill
km/hr)
in level flight.
.Cut off the hydraulic
pressure, using collective
lever pushbutton.
Control loads are felt:
-on collective
pitch
increase
-on forward and LH cyclic.
The horn stops (but the
rotor r.p.m. function
remains operative).
If necessary, increase
I.A.S.,
but the control loac
feedback will also increase.
.Make a flat approach over a
clear landing area and land
with slight forward speed.
Shut down the engine,
holding the collective
pitct
lever on the low pitch stop.
-In
hover
.Land
normally.
depressurizedby pressing
the HYD. TEST pushbutton.
Do not press the HYD.
DGAC
Approved:
3.1 paragraph 5
35082
:3.:3 4It
~
Page2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.Red
liQhts
(Cont'd)
Light
PH
BTP
Failure
Main gearbox oil
pressure
Pilot
minimum
action
MGB.P
R
R
R
R
R
R
.R
lH.BTP
max.
temperature
Battery
PH II
Engine oil
maximum te~erature
ENG P
MGB.T
T.BATT
BAT T.
-Test
pressure
alarm
-Isolate
the battery (pushbutton "OFF") and land as
soon as possible.
-Reduce power.
-Check engine oil
indicator:
pressure
.If pressure
is loworzero
read torquemeter :
.If
reading very low shut
down engine
.If
reading correct land
inmediately
.If
both pressure and
torquemeter readings are
correct,
land as soon as
possible.
I.
DGAC
Approved:
w
350
B2
3.3I
90-37
Page 3I
*01"
FLIGHT MANUAL
2.2
AnDer
liGhts
.
.I
Light
GENE
Failure
Pilot
-D.C.
power supply failure
(See NOTE1)
-Overvoltage
detected
GEN
action
-Test
the D.C. voltage.
-Check the position of the
push-button.
-Attempt
to reset
-If
unsuccessful:
Shed the least essential
consumer circuits;
continue
flight,
according to
circumstances,
keeping a ClOSE
check on voltage (22 volts
minimum).
-Maximum
flight timeon
battery :
Day:
50 mn.
Night:
20 mn.
-Land
(see NOTE2)
as soon as practicable.
Seealtitudelimitsafter
BATT
BAT
KLAXON
HORN
COMB
FUEL
fl ightat maximum
PITOT
(if
.,
fitted!
PORTES
Pitot
heating
system
not
-Check
continuous
Dower.
the push-button
(ON).
energized
-Monitor
DOORS
~
: If sliding
doors fitted
see relevant supplement.
airspeed indicator.
maximum).
R
DGAC
APproved:
W
350B2
~.~.
90-37 Page
4
CO
B
Illumination
CAPTION
-.
text as follows:
MAlFUNCTION
PILOT ACTION
IENG
CHI~ oilMetal
particles
inengineLand
assoon
aspossible
system.
IIIOTLIMI
I
I
-.
-OCoACApproved:
350
82
3.3
92-33
Page 5
~B2~
'-
FLIGHTMANUAL
[~~J
CAPnON
ENG CHIP
MALFUNCTION
Metal particles In engine 011system.
MOT LlM
PILOTACT10N
.
DGAC Approved:
IAI
350 B2
ICIDIEIFIGIHI
3.3
96-<J3
PAGE 5
C\
RRO~
FLIGHTMANUAL
.B
Illumination
AMS072598 :
in
of engine oil
pressure indicator
pointer.
10;
,DGACApproved:
~
~
350 B2
3.3
92-39
Page
"B2"5--
FLIGHT MANUAL
.2.2
Amberlights (Cond'd)
Light
FaIlure
Pilot
PORTES
DOORS
(Cont'd
~T LIM
-Maintain
low sink rate and flat
landing approach.
Metal particles
oil system
ENGCHIF
action
in engine
-Monitor
oil pressure variations.
the engine parameters (Ng-oi1
temp.) being identical.
If oil pressure increases by
1 bar approx. or if abnormal
hunting of torquemeter pointer
is notIced:
LAND AS SOON AS POSSIBLE
Inmediate1yafter
landing:
-Check the engine in accordance
with TURBOMECA
Maintenance
Manual.
-Otherwise.
remove the magnetic
plugs:
.If
fine metal powder is found.
clean the magnetic plug
(with electrIcal
indicating)
and fly to the nearest base
for carrying out the checks
specified In the TURBOMECA
MaIntenance Manual.
.If
shiny particles or dark
shavings are found on one of
the magnetic plugs. take-off
is PROHIBITEDuntil the checks
specifIed in TURBOMECA
Maintenance Manual are
performed.
.
.DGAC
Approved:
~
350B2
~.~
89-17
-'I
Page5
FLIGHT MANUAL
2.2
Amber
lights
(Cont'd)
Light
FILTRE C
Failure
Fuel filter
Pilot
clogging
Metal particles
in TGB
detected
LIMBTP Metalparticlesdetected
-Continue
flight
avoiding
prolonged hovering.
-Reduce
engine
power.
in MGB
-Monitor
MGB.P. and MGB.T.
lights.
Should either or both lights
illlJ11inate refer to illlJ11inatior
of relevant light (s),
in
*LIGHT* colunn.
CHIP MGB
P. COMB
FUELP.
action
F FILT
LIM BTA
CHIP TGB
(1524
m).
check the
-battery
of functions
-~
only:
: Battery,
on the
-Night: Same
asdayplus: Instrunent
lighting(1 and2),
-horizon,
DGAC
APproved:
~
position
lights,
anticol11sion
light.
350B2
B9-17
~.~
Page
6
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 4
NORMA~~~URES
CONTENTS
Pages
4.1
OPERATINGPROCEDURES
1
EXTERNALAND INTERNALCHECKS
CHECKSBEFORESTARTINGTHE ENGINE
1
3
3 STARTING
CHECKSBEFORETAKEOFF
.-6
5 TAKEOFF
6 CLIMBING
6
--7
APPROACH
AND lANDING
9 AFTER LANDING
4.2
10
11
DAILY CHECKS
.DGAC
IN-FLIGHT CHECKPROCEDURES
GROUND
CHECKPROCEDURES
Ng DIFFERENCECHECK
Approved:
W
ENGINEPOWERCHECK
-2
.4
350 B2
4.0.P
90-37
Page 1.
FLIGHT MANUAL
SEmON 4.1
OPERA~~-~~URES
1
EXTERNALCHECKS
~
-Check
-Carry
R
R
~,.-~-- 4~ ---"
.01
~~
3-__~
~7
>'
~
Figure 1
Station
-Total
pressure head (PITOn
-Landing
gear (cross-rneRtJers,
skids, wear-resistant
plates)
Station
-Port
2
hold ---Door
-Fuel
tank and system
-M.G.B.
cowl
-All
lower fairing
-Main Rotor Head
panels
-Hydraulic
Unit/System
-Engine Air Intake
-Rear hold
-Main
Rotor Blades
Station
-Oil
-Tail
-Tail
-Tail
.DGAC
3
leaks
boom and T.G.B.
Rotor Gear Box
unit
Approved:
W
fairings
locked).
350B2
4. 1
90-37
Page1
FLIGHT MANUAL
Station4
=-:;:~tor
-T.G.B.
Section
~~
blades--Condition
and Tail
boom fairings
of skin, no impact(dents,
-Starboardhold
If necessary:opendoor, checknoloose
objects,
-Landing
gear (crossmembers,
skids, wear resistant
plates)
-All
lower fairing
panels
-External
power receptacle door
-M.G.B.
cowl
-Security
-visual
check.
Closed, check.
-Closed,
check.
-Check engine oil level (steps).
-Foreign
objects on transmission
-Close cowl,check.
deck.
INTERNALCHECKS
-Cabin
-Fire extinguisher
Clean
Fitted
-Fuses
Fitted
-Objects carried
-Door jettison
Stowed
Checked
Figure 2
Item
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Description
Engine monitoring instrument!
and systems
Stand-by compass
Flight monitoring instrument!
Warning-Caution-Advisory
Panel
Yaw Control Pedals
Spare fuses
Cyclic stick grip
Cyclic stick friction
clamp adjuster
Fuse panel
Collective
pitch control
lever
Pilot and Copilot headset
jacks
Item
12
13
14
15
16
17
18*
19
20
21
Description
Utility
power outlet
Cabin heating (*) control
Demister control
Control Quadrant, comprising:
a) Rotor brake control
b) Fuel Flow Control lever
c) Starting
switch
d) Fuel shut-off
control
Collective
Pitch Lock (low
pitch)
Control console
Radio, I.C.S and Radio- Navigation -Control
Panels
Cabin ventilation
ports and
lighting
fixtures
O.A.T. Indicator
Instrument panel lighting
dimllerpotentiometers.
* Optional
DGAC
APproved:
W
35082
4.1 .
89-17
Page2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.Figure
2
I
':0;.:.
d
~l
I.9
SECOURS
P~GE
OUVERT
-: -om--
EMERGENCY
RANGE
~
CLOSED
2
CHECKS
BEFORESTARTINGTHE ENGINE
Determine
aircraft
performance
limits
for
the
expected
flying
conditions
(see kPERFORMANCEk
section)
Ensure
that
weight
and C.G.
limits
are observed.
-Seat
belts
NOTE,
Check particularly
-this
seat
-Battery
that
the
Adjusted
Fastened
co-pilot
seat
belt
is fastened
and Generator
in circuit
Switches
-ON-
.Lights
on with a/c battery
power:
HYD. GEN. MGBP. PITOT. ENG.P
.Lights
on with external
power:
HYD. GEN. MGB P. ENG P.
-Battery
when
is not occupied.
PITOT.
BAT
voltage
(1])
(4)
Checked
(1)
-Press
the HYD TEST pushbutton
for approx.
2 seconds to depressurize
the
yaw hydraulic
accumulator
in order to center the yaw pedals
(5) (1])
-Flight
controls
-Cyclic
pitch
-Collective
low pitch
control
pitch
stick
control
,
lever,
-Cyclic
stick
friction
lock
-Collective
lever friction
lock
-Rotor
brake released
-Fuel
shut-off
lever
lockwired
-Fuel
Flow Control
DGACApproved:
[g
,.
,.
Freedom of travel
(5) (])
Neutral
(])
Locked
(10)(16)
Adjusted
Adjusted
Forward
Forward
Off
(B)
(10)
(15a)
(15d)
(15b)
350 B2
(10)
lI.JL
89-1]
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
-Test Warning-Caution-Advisory
Panel lamps -WILT TEST
(FIRE light illumination
time delay = approx. 1 sec.)
(17)
-Ng difference indicator:
.Test """""""""""
Ng difference equal to zero.
Ng displayed equal to theoretical
"Ng.MAXTIO PWR"(see section 4.2).
.Bleed valve flag
Visible
(4)
-Hydraulic
pressure
On
(10)
(If isolated the HORNlight will come on)
-Heating system'", demister, air
conditionerOff
(13X14X21)
-Gyroscopic
instrllTlents
On
(17)
.\
~
to Figure 2)
-Switch
the booster
pumps..
.Check: on -Fuel
quantity
-Fuel
On console
.iii (17)
",:,"
(15c)
(15b)
-1(Y~RN~i~~g~im~~~~~~~~.
~~~~~~~~~~~.
~~.~~~.
~~~~~~
-KLAXON (HORN) light
-Check
aural warning
flashing
operates
Check NR -pointer
in the green zone of the indicator,
the lower limit .'."'..'.."
"..""".""."'.'.."'...
.Check:
fuel flow control in "f11ght" position.
J (4)
near
(3)
DGAC
Approved:
[]
350
B2
4.1.
89-17
Page 4
FLIGHT MANUAL
-Disconnect
external
power,
if
used
..~~~~~s:o~~r~~~:~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~.~~~~~.~:~.~~~.~~:
-Switch
on PITOT heating
On pedestal
(4)
panel
go out
(4)
-Check:
.All
warning and caution lights
off
.Electrical
system voltage and current
.Engine
-Run
oil
pump separately
fuel
pressure
is correct
FUEL P. warning
light
is
-Switch
(4)
(1)
pressure
each booster
.The
.The
on/engage all
on
or in light
-Carry
out a hydraulic accumulator test:
.Check:
collective
pitch -locked
.Cut off hydraulic pressure by actuating the test
push-button
On console
.Check that the HYD light illuminates
and HORNsounds
.Move the cyclic stick 2 or 3 times along both axes
separately on 10 % of total travel,
check for hydraulic
(17)
rain.
(10)(16)
(17)
assistance
by
(17)
goes out.
-Carry
out a hydraulic pressure isolation
check:
.Isolate
hydraulic pressure by actuating
the switch on the
collective
pitch lever:
the HYD light illuminates
and
control load is felt immediately, except on yaw pedals, where
control load should remain low because of load-compensating
.Restore
servo.
hydraulic
until
pressure
goes out (2 -3
the HORNsounds
sec.).
* Optional
.DGAC
Approved:
350 82
4.1
89-17
c..
.".,..,c.., ,..'.","","-
"ce",
Page 5
FLIGHT MANUAL
CHECKSBEFORETAKE-OFF
-Doors
-Rad~o
-Navigation
naviga~ion.*
-Radlo conmunlcatlon
-General
and cyclic friction
clamps
Closed
Tests, correct operation
R.
Adjusted
Correct
-All warning
andcautionlights
Out
5~
Take off by gradually increasing the collective pitch and maintain hover,
head into wind, at a height of about 5 ft (1.5m).
Check that the engine and transmission monitoring instruments are within
their nonnal operating ranges.
For transition from hover, increase speed without increasing the power
demand(power required for hover I.G.E.) and without climbing until I.A.5.
is 40 kt (74 km/hr).
MQIl : The bleed valve flag disappears when the valve closes.
The bleed valve is nonnally open when the engine is shut down,
during starting and at low power. Bleed valve closing dependson the
O.A.T. and on the altitude as shownin the following table of Ng
values at which the bleed valve should close.
Zp (ft)
2000087.1
94
95.6
1500085.987.789.4
10000
90.1
85
86.788.4
8
".500084.285.987.689.4
91.893.4
95
91 92.694.1
96.3
95.696.9
~
0
88.790.4
-40
-10
-30
-20
20
30
40
50
( .C )
* Optional
DGAC
Approved:
W
350B2
90-37
4. 1.
Page
6,
"
EJ
paragraph 4
COO1Plete
the collective
and cyclic
-Collective
friction
and cyclic
friction
cl~s
pilot action.
8.-
DGAC
Approved:
m
350B2
4.1
92-33
Page6
*B2*
FLIGHT MANUAL
.5~
-Climb to a height of at least 100 feet (30m), while maintaInIng the same
power setting.
Set an I.A.S. of 55 knots (102 km/h) or that shown at point C on the
height/airspeed
diagram if greater than 55 knots.
-Above
100 ft (30m) the max. continuous
power
speed of 55 kt (102 km/h) may be assumed.
and the
optimum climbing
CRUISINGFLIGHT, MAOOEUVRES
7.1
Cruising
FlIght
Manoeuvres
-Maximlln load factor in turns is felt in the form of servo-control
"transparency" ; this phenomenonis smooth, and presents no danger.
-In maximumpower configuration,
it is advisable to decrease collective
pitch slightly
before initiating
a turn, as in this manoeuvre power
requirement is increased.
-In hover, avoid rotation faster than 5 seconds for one full rotation.
8
APPROACH
ANDLANDING
8.1
Approach
-Final
approach should be made into the wind at a low sink rate and
recOllY11ended airspeed
of 55 knots
(120 km/hr).
8.2~
.DGAC
Approved:
m
350 B2
LI. JL
B9-17
Page 7
---~
FLIGHT MANUAL
9 AFTER
LANDING
it
out,
1n
.depressurize
.recenter
the
order
to
hydraulic
accunulator.
if required.
are not
.
DGAC
Approved:
m
350
B2
lI.Jl.
89-17
Page8
.
.
FLIGiT MANUAl
EI
Paragraph 9 AFTERLANDING
2nd. sub-paragraph read:
-Wait 30 seconds until temperatures have stabilized.
67 .70% by retarding fuel flow control.
reducing Ng to
.
.
I);A.CApproved
IAI
ICIDr-EIFIGIHI
350 62
4.1
94-05
Page 8
*62*
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
11
DAILY OPERATINGCHECKS
~::lY helicopter
operation requires three checks:
-check before the first
flight
of the day,
-check
in conjunction with flight,
-check after the last flight
of the day.
These daily checks may be carried out by qualified
maintenance
personnel or by a qualified
pilot.
Any alteration
or detailed inspection to determine serviceability
as a
result of these checks must be done under the supervision of a properly
endorsed Aircraft
Maintenance Engineer and duly entered in the Aircraft
Log Book.
Checks before the first
11.1
fliaht
Outside checks
~:
IF THE AIRCRAFTHAS BEENGROUNDED
FOR MORETHAN ONEWEEK, BEFORE
OPERATINGTHE FLYING CONTROLS,WIPE THE SERVOCONTROl
PISTON RODSWITH
A RAG IMPREGNATED
WITH SERVICEFLUID.
-Check that the area is clean and clear.
-Remove the blade socks, if applicable.
-Perform
the following checks.
~ 5-,
4-n""'",
/(~~~=~~~
~
~,~~~~~~~~~~~~
.~
""':::~;~~2
II
""""""'~,-3-1J..,
,.,.
.../
STATION1
-Transparent
panels ,.."..".'"
Cleanliness
-Pi tot heads and static
vents ...Blanking
cover,
-Sideslip
indicator
Condition
drain
removed
N
..DGAC
Approved:
350 B2
4.1
90-37
Page 9
*01*
.~"'..
,,"
FLIGHT MANUAL
STATION 2
~~
air intake
-MGB """"""""""""""
-Open the engine cowling:
.Transmission
deck and engine..
-Close
the engine cowling
-Tail
pipe cover
-Fuel
tank
-Filler
cap
-LH baggage cn1Jartment door
-Lower cowlings
-Aft
baggage compartment
-Main rotor blades
STATION 3
-Tail
-TGB
Security
Oil level
STATION 4
-Tail
-Tail
rotor blades
boom and TGB fairings
Condition
Security
of skin
STATION 5
-RH baggage con1Jartment
.Battery
.Loads
Open
Connection
Tied down,
Close and lock compartment
door ...Closed
Condition, cleanliness
Oil level
Correctly
locked
STATION 6
-Collective
pitch control
and yaw pedals
-Gas generator control
-Rotor
brake control
-Fuel
shut-off
control
-Fire
extinguisher
Free travel
Free movement
Free movement
Forward position,
In place
DGACApproved:
350 B2
4.1
90-37
Page 10
.~
~
B
.
-DGAC-APproved:
W
35082
4.1
92-33 Page
11
"82"
FLIGHT MANUAL
check consists
in :
-checking
fluid levels,
-a rapid check of the main and tail
rotor blade skins,
-checking
that all loads are securely tied down, baggage co~artment
doors and cowlings are correctly
locked.
Should the turnaround time be prolonged, short-term picketing of the
aircraft
is recomnended : blanking plugs, covers fitted,
even blade
socks and poles in winds greater than 40 knots.
REMOVED
BEFORE
THENEXTFLIGHT.
.
N
.DGAC
Approved:
350 B2
~. 1
90-37
"'"
",c
Page11
,,"",..c",'"
FLIGHT MANUAL
11.3Check
afterthe1astfl iahtafthedav
(AlF)
~:
This check maintains the aircraft
flightworthy.
It consists in carrying
out a visual or tactile
examination of the condition of a component, an
assembly so as to detect defects which could affect correct operation,
but does not require the use of any special techniques or tooling.
Pay particular
attention
to the elements marked with an asterisk "*".
~
: Magnetic plugs which do not have an electric
indicating
system
may be checked for metal chips during the AlF check nearest to
the 3D-flying
hour limit.
NOTE8 : This check for
-nearest
defects
tothe3D-flying
hour
limit.
(AlFCHECK)
STATION1
-All
transparent
panels .'"
Cleanliness
(clean if
-Door jambs, canopy arch members. No faults
nor cracks
-Cabin
access door
Security and correctly
-Pi tot heads and static
vents ...Fit
blanking covers
required)
locked
STATION2
-lH
Condition,
security,
open, all
objects tied down, close and lock
.
N
DGAC
Approved:
W
350
82
~. 1.
90-37 Page
12I
.FLIGiT
MANUAL
EI
Paragraph 11_3 -Check After the Lasr Flight of the Day (AlF)
Station 1
C~lete
-Sliding
.
.
Ix;AC Approved
.-IAI
ICIDIEIFIGIHI
350 82
4 -1
93-50
Page 12
*62*
FUGHT MANUAL
.[~~
Paragraphe
11.3
After "~".
please
IMPORTANT:
For the ARRIEL lDl engines not modified TU 197 nor TU 202.
When shutting down the engine after the last flight of the day. confirm that there is
no abnormal noise during the autorotation
of the gas generator. This check can be
performed
completion
of 0 cranking operation of no more than
5 seconds.
immediately onafter
engine shutdown.
-
.
.DGAC
~~
APproved:
IAllclDIEIFIGIHI
350 B2
4.1
94-08
PAGE 12
.RR.
"
..FLIGHT
MANUAL
B
REPLACES THE INFORMATIONS CONTAINED IN RR 2 H.
Paragraph 113
.This
.hour
IMPORTANT:
check for defects can be performed during the ALF check before the 3D-flying
or 150 operating cycle limit
.
./
.
DGACApproved
IAI
ICIDIEIFIGIHI
35082
4.1
97-42
Page 12
"RR.
"" k
,..."
.I
FLIGHTMANUAL
[~J
Paragraph 11.3 -Check
S1Q1iQn-2
Complete
-DUNLOP servocontrols
leading to seepage
DGAC Approved:
IAlclDIEIFIGIHI
350 B2
4.1
97-11
page
.R"
8
~
-c
..
FLIGHT MANUAL
B
Paragraph 113
~
-LH
landing gear
Shock absorber
Wear resistance plate
-Bidirectional
cross beam
pre Mod. 07-2720
.,...
Condition
Condition. no leaks
Condition
..
.
.
\.~
DGAC Approved:
IAlclDIEIFIGIHI
350 B2
4.1
97-42
Page 13
*RR*
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
Condition, no leaks
Condition
Open: condition of systems.
locking system
-MGB oil
Check level
-Transmission
deck
Cleanliness
-MGB suspension bars
Security
-Servocontrols,
hydraulic system. Security.
no leaks, lines
-Hydraulic
reservoir
Check fluid level,
security
-Cooling
fan
Motor security,
condition of blades
-Fuel
filter
Security;
check paint marks;
clogging indicator
not visible
-Universal
joint assembly
Security,
pins in place and locked
-MAIN ROTORSHAFT
'" Swashplate bearing:
be performed within
minutes after rotor
check to
five
stops
.Scissors,
swashplates,
swivel bearings
rods,
.Swashplate/pitch
change rod
end-fitting
interface
'" Pitch
point
No traces of contact,
paint scaling
on swashplate attachment yokes
change rods
PIN 350A37.1S0B.00
to
.05
or play.
'" Spherical
and frequency
thrust adapters
bearings
end-fitting
paint
and aligned
no craks,
corrosion
nor
Security,
general condition
No delamination (splinters)
No cracks
No elastomer
scratches,
faults.
blisters.
unbonding,
extrusion,
cracks.
N
.DGAC
Approved:
W
350 B2
4.1
90-37
Page 13
"'01'"
FLIGHT MANUAL
adapter
.Self-lubricating
bearings
-Flared
housing magnetic plug
-Shock mount.
* MAIN ROTORBLADES
and
.Systems
metal
condition
of skin,
no
condition,
cleanliness
No leakage
.Controls
.Transmission
deck drain
-Freewheel
Interference
Not plugged
rotor:
-Tail
-Aft
"
shim.
SEE NOTEB
No debris nor play. SEE NOTEB
...No metal chips. SEE NOTEA
Security
Security,
-Engine
air intake
.Aerospatia1e
air intake
-Engine cowling..
-Engine mount
-Engine
and engine compartment
.Engine and accessories
the
SEENOTEB
Security. blanking cover fitted
pipe
closing
STATION3
-Horizontal
stabilizer,
fin,
tail bumper
-TGB
Security, condition
Oil level, no leaks
STATION
4
-TGB
shaft
No play
.Sealant
Condition
bead
.Magnetic plug
-Horizontal
tail
stabilizer,
bumper
Security, condition
DGAC
APproved:
w
350 82
4.1
90-37
Page14:
"01*
FLIGHT MANUAl
.[~~~
Complete
the checks
with :
~:
-Gas generator
ARRIEl 1 D1 engine not modified
TU 197 nor TU 202
.abnormal
.
.DGAC
Approved:
IAI
IclDIEIFIGIHI
350 82
4.1
94-08
PAGE 14
*RR'
FUGH\'"';v1ANUAt:
RR 20 SUPERSEDES RR 2L
Paragraph 11.3 : Check After the Last Flioht of the Dav (ALA
STATION 4
-TRH
R
R
R
.
Figure 3
0
0
.;0
~
DGAC Approved:
IAI
ICIDIEIFIGIHI
350 82
.
4.1
00-41
Page 15
'RR'
FLIGHT MANUAL
[~~J
Paragraph
11.3-Check
.
.
~
Complete the checkswith:
-DUNLOP servocontrols
()
\.
.
DGAC Approved:
IAlclDIEIFIGIHI
350 82
97-11
pagel
.RR
4.1
0- " .
FLIGHT MANUAL
B
Paragraph 113
~
-RH
landing gear
,
Shock absorber
Wear resistance plate .""",."",..,
-Bidirectional
cross beam
pre Mod 07-2720
...Check
Condition
Condition. no leaks
Condition
;---\
.
.
-0
DGAC Approved.
IAICIDIEIFIGIHI
350 B2
4.
97-42
Page 15
*RR*
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
,. TAIL ROTORBLADES"""'..."'.
,. Tail
rotor
.Laminated
blade spar
half-bearing
.Blade horn
-nlR
.Pitch
change control
.Pitch
change rod swivel
bearing
:'
Security,
general condition of skin,
no dents, no bonding separation on
the stainless
steel leading edge.
Check for abnonnal spar noise when
the rotor is bent inwards and
outwards to form an arc.
SEE NOTEB
No bonding separation,
deep crack or
emergence
No play
Condition,
security
No play.
SEE NOTEB
,. BALANCEARMHINGE: (Flapping
hinge bearing) according to
type:
.Type 1 : cups on either side
of the pin
Security
Security,
condition,
locking
Condition,
no leaks
Condition
Open: condition of locking
Cleanliness
Leaktightness
No metal chips. SEE NOTEA
Security
Security,
no leaks,
Oil 1:ve1, security,
Securlty,
no leaks
systems
lines
tightness
.DGAC
Approved:
W
350 B2
4.1
90-37
Page 15
*01*
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
-Universal
joint
-Engine mount
assembly
.Systems
.Controls
.Transmission
deck drain
Security,
pin fitted
Condition,security
General
condition,
Noleaks
Interference
cleanliness
Not plugged
* MAGNETIC
PLUG
-ARRIEl
.Aft
reduction gear magnetic
plug
-Pre-modification
TU 135
Daily check
-Post-modification
TU 135 ...SEE NOTEA
.m
reductiongearoptional
magnetic plug
-Engine
and MGBcowlings.
SEE NOTEA
Closing,
locking
STATION 6
-Seat
-Cabin
Security,pin in place
Generalcleanliness
.
N
DGAC
APproved:
W
350B2
4.1 .
90-37
Page 16
EJ
The check of the ARRIELengine magnetic plugs is modified as follows:
-ARRIEL engine magnetic plugs
without electrical indication.
-Aft
reduction
gear magnetic
Check every
daily.
5 flying
hours and
See ~
.
DGACAPproved:
W
350 82
4.1
92-33
Page 16
*82"
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION
4.2
ENG~~-;~HECK
1
IN-FLIGHT CHECKPROCEDURE
The engine power check is made in flight.
1.1
Record of oarameters
-Fly
a stabilized,
level course, preferably
at an altitude
where there
is little
or no turbulence;
shut off heating and demisting.
-Set the engine speed to the maximum compatible with the mechanical
limitation
(torque no higher than 94 %) and Ng limit (M.C.P.). The
bleed valve flag should not be visible
in these conditions.
-Record
1.2
the following
parameters:
torque,
O.A.T..
in the direction
indicated
by the arrows,
-Torque
-NR -Altitude
-O.A.T.
-Ng
entering
as
and
to locate
: -If
"p"
"p".
is located
-If
2
point
point
necessary,
Ng and NR indicating
systems.
GROUND
CHECKPROCEDURE
The engine power check cannot be carried out at high power level
ground with a high-power single-engine
helicopter
of this type.
Before forward flight
in a 5 ft hover, increase the collective
enough to ensure a momentary Ng increase of at least 1 %.
After having reached a safe altitude,
check may be performed.
a normal inflight
on the
pitch
power assurance
.DGAC
Approved:
W
350 B2
4.2
90-37
Page1,
FlIGHT MANUAL
(.~o) ::!:!::::;:;::::,:!::::!::::!:!:!:::::::!:::!::::;::l::::!::::;::::::,:::::.:::::::::::i::::::::!:::::::::~:::::::;:::::.::::::::::::::':::::::::
.*
40 :::::::.
:;:: ::::::::::;:;::;;
::::; :::;::
::::
:: ;;;c
:::::::::::::::::::::::::::::::
INCORRECT
:::::::::::::
::;:::::;;:::::::::::::.:::;:.::::::::::.:::::::::::-;;:::::
30
:.:::::::::::.:::::;::.:.:.:.:.:.;.:..:.:...
::"..;:::.:
.:.: .,., ,:., '" ,.. ,.,.:.:.,..,.::
..:.:. :. ,:.: : "'.': ,c :""'.
:::::;'::..:::::::: ::::::::"::..:::::::..':,,;:::::::
:"'.:.,:
.c"c.cc.c'c'.c.
,,: .,.:,
:: ,:: .:.:: co'
'""'
: .:.,.,. ,,: ,:,.,.
..'c.'.'c.'.".'...'.'.'.
,:20-:.':::::::::"':;::::::::.:::::=-'.::::;::':'c::::::..::::.:::::;:::::::';".::::;
~
'
.:.:::;.'...:. .:::':c;;::.:
.;:::
;:: c;":::;::.;::::.:::;:
0
c "gcc
~ :0
t-
CORRECT
~:: :-;at~~
.100
.-".
~
r\"
~ -.~
~
"
~
~ 50
"
cc
c c
..ccc
00
.""'C
.". ".
'...
.'.'."
'.
.:
-30
(ftx100) "
.c.
:.
"
(,.,,100)
~"
30
'"'
: "
.-~-
-r\
~
r-,
~
'
",
"
20,
"
1\
"\
1\
"-
.~
r\
i'
r\'
1\
10
~"
1\
~tr-/lDn~ -..
400
0
"
"
.390
CO
.z
0
"!
~
a:
01
0
l'
380
U1 lc
cJI ~(
I
COUPLE TORQUE (X)
ENGINE POWERCHECK
DGAC
Approved:
w
35082
4.2 (I!
89-17
Page 2
--
FLIGHT MANUAL
NQ DIFFERENCE
-Record
INDICATOR
CHECK
the prevailing
-Determine
pressure-altitude
the theoretical
IH~EMP.
EXT. -4D
Hp-Zp O.A.T. a
(It)
10'0
and O.A.T.
values.
20'0
25'0
30'0
35'0
40'0
45'0
50'0
+5'0
-1000
~'III~~~t
1000
:~~::::::~~:!;~:::::~~~:
101.7 101.6 101.5 101.3 101.2 101.0 100.9 100.7
3000
5000
the test
The following
1)
2)
push-button.
readings are displayed
successively
'Q~:=10.
then:
'L.L.L'
---(code
probe:
in the window:
indicating
correct operation
see NOTE1). then:
of the O.A.T.
!!QIU :
is equal to the
aa
LL
a~'
L,
,
defective
operation
Ng displayed
is equal
power).
the pointer
(open circuit).
to 98 % within
0.2
should
read -3.5.
% (Max.
lilt
DGAC
Approved:
m
35082
~.~
90-37
Page 3I
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 5
REGULATOR~~~~~NCE
DATA
CONTENTS
Pages
INTRODUCTION
SUBSTANTIATED
WIND ENVELOPE
3 A.S.I.
4
CALIBRATION
SPEEDVERSUSHEIGHT ENVELOPE
.2
5 HOVERPERFORMANCE
I.G.E.
(Height 5 ft -1.5
m)
6 HOVERPERFORMANCE
O.G.E.
RATESOF CLIMB
NOISE LEVELS
12
,!
I'
[I
DGACApproved:
W
350 82
!).().f>
90-37
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION5
REGULATOR~~RMANCE
DATA
1
INTRODUCTION
The following
performance curves apply to the basic version of the
aircraft.
Refer to the supplements when optional
equlpment is fitted.
2
2.1
SUBSTANTIATED
WIND ENVELOPE
Wind envelope for
for winds of
3 ASI CALIBRATION
0
150 I
50
I
100
I
150
I
200
I
250 (km/h)
I ...E
(k1)
?'
ili
f"
111
P250
i100
~
200
//
/
;;
150
.J
-<.J
-'I
100
60
/V"
I.,;-:
1//
50
0:
~
>
.DGAC
Approved:
W
00
60
100
(kt) 160 0
350 B2
5. 1
90-37
Page1
FLIGHT MANUAL
AIRSPEED-HEIGHTENVELOPE
The avoidance zone (2) is defined
by four points:
A, B, C, D.
at a height
of 8 ft
at a height
of 25 ft
of 40 knots
.
and on the aircraft
.
DGAC
APproved:
w
350
82
5.1
.
89-17
Page2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.~OO
~ 7000
-:
~6000"
1\1I I'
B~I
l"e\j'g
~
;t; 5000
0
...~";4000 -Mf~
II 1/
II.IJ
iI'
I
1/
II
/
'
---0-4-
---
..:3000
t;
cf
I
2000
1000
If
J
If
-31 -~ -10 0 10 ~ 31 .0
TEIt'. EXT.10.A.T. I'CI
~
40
35
50
a
1ft)
D
':!'.
.:~.:..
400
:~:~;:;::
::: ~~..
~ ...:.:f:...;.:!i.':i:i;~~~t.
200
I~
.0
C
10
20
30
40
5OIkt)60
"
=0
"0
,;
~
DGAC
Approved:
[I]
"-
350B2
!5.Jl
B9-17
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
5 /-K)VER
PERFORMANCE
I.G.E.
20000
18000
+++j
j-j:-f-+++j-j-f++6000
111]
::::
l: 1111
-1-l11
:::: ::::
-fttj
+j:-ft+t;..!-~t
-fti-i
I -It+i':""'"
~16000:'::
+++:
-ii-It
~
5000
j-ji-f+++jj.f+:
14000Wi-i1tt j-!i-r
! mf~
.4000:
CI1
+++;....;++i-j-.+
; -;++;- ++
~ ::::
~~
! 1tt~
Z
0
t-
3000~
: iiii Ii:'
r ~~t1:
:;~++
-i.-i.L'
6000t++!
i -l-i.Li
i-l-i.L 2000
f t++~
-~Ht
ii:i
':i: :i'i Ii::
4000+++1-f-f++
t!-f-f++]:1:
:;+++
:j:;:r:;
i::i :::, :::: ::': :::: -i-;-;-;
::::
-;;-i-;--;-;-;+i-i-;-;i-;-j-;--;-;+i~ 2000~~;--;-~~~
;-;-i~
~~j-;.
-~l~~
-;-;-l-~
""
1-10~0 iili~
,."
""
~ ~~~~
1500
3010~..35~~
.,
, :::: i:i:
f +++]:
~+++ 1000
:; +.;.;.,.
:::: ..-;-;+
::::
~~~l;..;~l~
""
,,',
""
+1:1:t::[~+t:i:t:tI
i ~~
2000
220
-~05
(kg) 2500
MASSE WEIGHT
CONDITIONS
/-K)VERPERFORMANCE
-Height 5 ft -1.5
-No P2 air bleed
DGAC
Approved:
I.G.E.
35082
~. JL
89-17
/'
Page4
FLIGHTMANUAL
.20000
+++
++j-j-f+++
j-\-f+
tj i-\-+++j-i-i-fi 6000
'"
,.,
'"
'"
~1BOOO:::
~
'I~
",'
,,"
",'
",'
,."
""
,.,
",.
;:::::::::::
i-i ;-;- -f+i-i::::
::::
:,::
::::
+++
:::
:::
""
",'
""
""
~
e
~
-H++
I:::
I:::
UJ16000:::
++i-
;.;
;.;.-,+;.;..;-;+-, 5000 0Z
::::::::::::
1it: :;:t11
+i:-i-ftti..I-fi-f
-J
([
14000
:::: ;;
;;
::::
;;;;
Q..
UJ
-'-"-,- -,-,-"-
iiij--i-iii
::::
::::
UJ
0012000::::::::
:.::
a:
Q..
4000
::::
10000
+ttj-
""
""
""
".,
,,',
""
""
.,.,
~~
.".
.",
""
".' ~
BOOO ++~j. i-f++
.J
<I
""
".,
"..
~~
",.
.",
""
",.
",.
".,
".,
,..,
,..,
~~
""
",.
",.
.',.
i-1-f-f
""
""
,,"
,."
""
,."
"" "-"- -,-,-,,',
~i-i-i- -f-f++
3000
,..,
,..,
""
-"---,-""
-i-f-f-f
J.J.i
6000
2000
+:1
."
4000 I::
;::
".
'"
e:-
.".
tti-i-
-H-tt .j-j-rt
,
",.
++'
""
;I:::; ;; ::::
;;:;
tti
2000
I-
,.,.
,."
,."
+;';.1-w-;.;.
::::
i:::
",.
",.
""
~~~..".
0
0
,.
.",
';';'H--W;';'
:::
:::
: : ::
::::
'"
' I::
;;:;
.",
1000
"
""
.",
H-;-'
::::
::::
""
,."
".,
.,.,
;-1'-i--;;.;-1--w-;-;
::::
:::
::::
::::
::::
::::
::::
::::
111;-!-~++
~j-i-~
~~;.j.
-~.~++
-j-j-i-~
ill::::[III:::::[IIJ::[:[li]::::[:U
-10~0
+t~-
-j.~+t +1-H +++1- -f-f++ -j.H+ +++1. .Ht+ -1-H-:- +11-1+U+ -1~++
1500
~O~~ ..~510~
..~O~~
.,
2000
MASSE WEIGHT
22
~510~ .,
0 (kg)
~b~~ ~ 1~)'
-:05
2500
CONDITIONS
HOVERPERFORMANCE
-Height
-Heating
.DGAC
5 ft -1.5
m
do demisting
systems
Approved:
m
I.G.E.
on
350 82
!J.jl
89-17
Page5
6 HOVER
PERFORMANCE
O.G.E.
20000
; j
FLIGHT MANUAL
6000
3000
2000
1000
0
-305
-1
l([
Page6
.
~.jl.
~~
4000
g .
00
~
0
5000
18000
w 16000
:)Q
I-
~ 14000
~
I/)
8000
4000
MASSE
WEIGHT
O.G.E,
350
B2
89-17
f>VERPERFORMANCE
2202 _'-,;~~
..45100'
"sb1oo ~k~)
' (l'b;~5?0
"0
bleed
2000
6000
"
~
1
ll:
Q.
0
"'0
'"
2: -1000
~0
10000
I/)
w 12000
'~
.00
.UJ
'I-
+'
---
_1~02
3000
' , 35100 ..40.00
wind
P2 air
CONDITIONS
-No
-No
DGAC
Approved:
m
FLIGHT MANUAL
.20000
6000
i
~
18000
..
'~
+'
't-
-I
16000
'
+.-
I-
..;;:;
cn
"
...0
~ 14000
w
~
.;9:
a.
.T
UJ
:.
J.
:>
I i
~ 12000
UJ
4000
:::.
,~t-
10000,
.:..
I:.
8000
c
~
~..
UJ
[:
-..5000z
'0
:>
3000
..~~
...
2000
6000
..-
4000
1000
0
2000
.;01
'"
.5
0
~
-1000.
305
~010~
1500
'
,
~510~
MASSE
'
~010~
'
2000
, ~5~~
22
'
WEIGHT
.DGAC
Approved:
2500
~ l'b !
~~=J
f>VER
wind
-Heating
OCkgJ
~~IO~
'
CONDITIONS
-No
PERFORMANCE
OGE
B2
~.Jl
89-17
Page
7l
'",
FLIGHT MANUAL
7 RATE
OF
CLIMB
.
31 33
35
I /
36
'38
V I
1<1
42
0'
/
V
40
'0
48
..If
0\1
,it;
IltIl
"'If.
v:
52
..,\.64
-,*,M
1/
q I
il
:/
..06
...'
1~100)
,...
JIr: I,
'"
II
"!J /
/
.:
.,, :
il
I
'I
1 f
:',
.1.
; :
1/
II
1/ ;i'~
..
..
I
I
Taf'.EXT.
If
0
0"
~ 1
~
. II
0
-40 -30 -20 -10
.,
.,
i
..
;
10 20 30 00 50 60 1500
I O.A.T.
NOTE:
WeTght limitation
2250 kg (4961 lb)
C'C)
with
i;
2000
HASSE~!E
internal
DGAC
Approved:
m
load:
3000
I C(IICTED II:!GiT
CORRECTEDWEIGHT FOR
DETERMINING RATE-OF-CLIMB
(on facing
page)
350
B2
5.1 .
89-17 Page
8
'
"
Ii
FLIGHT MANUAL
.RATE
OF CLIMB(Cont'd)
...,..
--T--'
,-
--, -,--,-
," .
,.
. , ,.--,-
,
,
,.
-i-i- ,-i.1--
.I
i-1-.
-t-t-t.t-
-40-30-20-10
0 10 20 30 40 50
TEMP.EXT. to.A.T.
(OC)
CONDITIONS
~~
-MCP
-No
.DGAC
1CXX>
1~
VI~Is:.IRATEa:a.IIB
2(XX)
2500
[ft/m)
~~~
RATE OF CLIMB
P2 air bleed
Approved:
~
35082
!).jl
89-17
-~--
Page9I
, , ' ~,: r
:'
,
FLIGHT MANUAL
313335.
1,1'
II'
f'"
=
s8
..0
ltl
;0'
I'
042
-44
-45
/
0'
/-co
.1t;
-62
./'~
.c4
W~
"',,
/'
-65
/,,'.'1"'100)
Ij
(I
'"
-48
".l~
II
""
I,
.,
I~ I
t:r
I
I
I
I
./
.i
I.
! /
..
i i
-.,
; !
,//.
0
0
..I!
II
II
..-2
~
~
II
f:
, .
'
I!
10 20 30 40 50 60 1500
T94P.EXT.
I O.A.T.,00)
NOTE:
welght
limitation
2250 kg (4961 lb)
DGAC
Approved:
[]
! /
.'
I!
with
internal
;
2000
..-CORRI=
load:
3000
I ~TED
~IQjT
CORRECTEDWEIGHT FOR
DETERMINING RATE-OF-CLIMB
(on facing
page)
350B2
!JojL
B9-17
Page 10
...
, ii'
FLIGHT MANUAL
.RATE
OF CLIMB (Cont'd)
-I--r
.{.
.iii
.I
-40
-30
-20
-10
TEMP.EXT. IO.A.T.
10
1C)
500
1CXX>
1500
2(XX)
VI~IS:./R41E(Fa.I16
2500
I ft/m I
CONomONS
-C.A.S.
-MCP
= SS kt -102
-Heating
and demisting
.DGAC
Approved:
W
km/hr
systems
ON.
~~~~
RATE OF CLIM8
3S0 82
5. 1
89-17
Page 11I
FLIGHTMANUAL
NOISE LEVELS
Noise levels
EPNdB
Take off
89.8
93.5
Approach
91.4
94.5
Overflight
87.6
92.5
..
.
N
DGAC
Approved:
w
350
B2
5.1
.
90-37
--
Page12
..eurocopter
FLIGHT
MAN"AL
FLIG
HT
AS
MAN
UAL
350
82
.SUPPLEMENT
LIST OF SUPPLEMENTS
INCOMPATIBILITY OF UTILIZATION
EFFECT ON PERFORMANCE
DATA
DAILY CHECKSOF OPTIONAL INSTALLATIONS
.IMPORTANT
.The
NOTE
information
contained herein supplements
or supersedes
the informetion
given
In the basic flight manual and/or applicable
flight manual supplements.
The effectivity
of the supplement
at the latest revision is specified
on the List of
Effective Pages.
This
supplement
supports
and EUROCOPTER
Revisions
to this
seme procedures
-::;~::::'Ml
helicopters
delivered
by both
Direction
DGACApproved:
by EUROCOPTER
FRANCE
Technique
Support
FRANCE
Etabllssement
-13725
Marlgnane
350 B2
I FIG
AEROSPATIALE
FRANCE.
supplement
are made
as AEROSPATIALE.
EUROCOPTER
~?~--=jI:[
I A I B I ~ I DIE
the
I HI
using
de
the
Merlgnane
Cedex
-France
SUP.O.P1I
93-09
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
CUST~IZATION
:
...AIC
: AS 350 82 -SIN:
lIST
SECTION
PAGE
OF ADDITIONAL APPROVEDPAGES
---
DATECODE
SECTION
PAGE
DATECODE
THIS AIRCRAFTDOESNOTOFFERANYPARTICULAR
FEATURES
REQUIRING THE CUSTOMIZATIONOF THE FLIGHT MANUALON
GREENPAGES.
...
...
...
DGACApproved:
I A I 8 I C .to I ElF
350 82
IG I H I
SUP.O.P1
90-15
Page 3
--
..
FLIGHT MANUAL
LIST OF SUPPLEMENTS
.Some
supplements
covering
installations
helicopter
may be withdrawn from this
supplements
appears on this page.
No.
or procedures
not used on this
manual. The complete list
of
DESCRIPTION
RESERVED
.2
RESERVED
RESERVED
12
..13
SLIDING DOORS
14
SAND FILTER
15
RESERVED
16
17
EMERGENCYFLOAT,'\TIONGEAR
.R
DCAC
Approved:
350 82
SUP
92-40
.O.P2
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL.
t)
18
4t
19
RESERVED
20
RESERVED
21
FORWARDTWO-PLACESEAT
22
RESERVED
23
24
RESERVED
25
28
.R
4t
SPECIAL SUPPLEMENTS
50
56
ABSEILINGINSTALLATION
-4t
DGACApproved
350 82
4t
5UP.O.P2
page2
-
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF CONDITIONAL REVISIONS (RC)
...The
Supplements contain
when the conditions
are
the following
complied with.
pink
cancelled
CAUTION
IF A NORMALREVISION (RN) MODIFIES THE PAGE NUMBERFOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNEDBELOW, THE READER WILL HAVE TO CHANGETHE NUMBEROF THE PINK
PAGE BY HAND, SO THAT THE INFORMATION REMAINS IN ACCORDANCE
WITH THE
PARAGRAPHCONCERNED.
...
Sup.
Page
Date
Applicable
before
condition
is met :
II
...
NOTE:
the
last
two digits
DGACApproved:
I A I B I C I D j ElF
350 B2
I G IHI
SUP.O.P3
90-15
Page 1
---
FLIGHT MANUAL
-COMPOSITION
U
OF RUSHREVISIONS
(RR)
SUPPLEMENT
NoRR
SUP.O
SUP.11
DGACApproved:
[]
2A
PAGE
DATE
CODE
P4.1
99-37
98-43
SUPPLEMENT
35082
NoRR
PAGE
DATE
CODE
5UP.O.P4
99-37
Page 1
*RR*
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF RUSH REVISIONS (RR)
TheSupplements
contains
thefollowingadditionalyellowpage(s)
:
No.
SUP.
-PAGE
CODE
DATE
No.
SUP.
-PAGE
CODE
DATE
~
DGACAPproved:
I A I 8 I C I DIE
350 82
I FIG
I H r
SUP.O.P4
90-15
Page 1
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
LIST OF APPROVED
EFFECTIVEPAGES
DOT CERTIFICATION
(1)
Page Revision
Code
-R : Revised,
to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PI
PI
P2
P2
P3
P4
PS
DATE
1
3
1
2
1
1
1/01
1
2
3
4
5
6
93-09
90"715
92-40
99-45
90-15
90-15
99-45
99-37
92-40
99-37
90-37
90-37
90-37
(1)
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
DATE
(1)
.
LIST OF THE LATEST NORMAL
APPROVED REVISIONS
No
Date
No
89-17
99-37
90-15
99-45
90-37
92-40
93-09
DGAC Approved:
w
NORMAL REVISION:
Date
350 82
SUP
99-45
.O.PS
Page 1
,,"
FLIGHT MANUAL
2
.The
Incompatibility
Master Servicing
Operation
of
installations:
and covers
incompatible
only
with
of installation
between items
Recommendations (PRE).
stated
in the
the following
:
ITEM
Makes operation
with the
following
equipment items
impossible.
SUPPL.
No.
15
Emergency floatation
17
32* -66
17
Float
type undercarriage
15
32 -70
21
Ferry
flight
50
22 -23
-32
-41
-68
-72
22
External
load carrying
installation
"CARGO5LING"
12
21 -25
-32
-44
-46
-66
23
External
load carrying
installation
"CARGOSWING"
11
21 -25
-32
-44
-46
-66
25
Air
-22
-23
-32
-41
-72
32
Electric
15*- 17 -21
41 -44
-46
-22
-66
-23
51
21 -25
-32
-44
-46
21
22 -23
-32
-41-
72
-22
-23
-32
-41-
72
56
15 -22
-23
-32
-44
-46
ambulance
Crop spraying
44
Forward
46
Blind
flying
installation
18
installation
seat
screens
installation
TAP kit
70
T 31 Automatic
72
Water bomber
remain possible
DGACApproved:
tank
two-place
68
* Hoisting
gear
hoist
abseiling
[]J
fuel
41
.66
is non-exhaustive
items which are
-25
-21
pilot
system
when the
floats
16
17
53
21 -25
are folded.
350 B2
SUP.O
99-37
Page 1
'FLIGHT MANUAL
...
REGULATORYPERFORMANCE
DATA
-Take-off
weights
Whenthe installation
of an optional equipment item modifies the takeoff weights specified in the basic Flight Manual, the take-off weights
are indicated on new charts.
-Rates
of climb
When the rates of climb are modified, the relevant Supplement either
provides a new chart or prescribes a reduction with respect to the '"
basic performance.
3.2
ADDITIONAL PERFORMANCE
DATA
-The
DGAC
APproved:
I A I 8 I c I~ I E IF I G I H I
.
.
350 82
SUP.O
92-40
Page 2
---
FLIGHT MANUAL
4
.For
item
installed
on the
helicopter,
the
daily
check before
the first
flight
of the day,
check after
the last flight
of the day.
These daily
checks may be carried
out by qualified
maintenance
personnel
or by a qualified
pilot.
Any alteration
or detailed
inspection
to determine
serviceability
as a
result
of these checks must be done under the supervision
of a properly
endorsed Aircraft
Maintenance
Engineer and duly entered
in the Aircraft
Log Book.
These checks consist
in performing
a visual
examination
equipment item in order to check its aeneral condition
aircraft,
in particular
for:
-windshield
wipers,
-fire
extinguisher,
-ski
installation,
-air
ambulance installation
-flares,
-cargo
swing,
-ferry
tank,
-blade
protection
against
-sand
filter.
The optional
below.
equipment
of each optional
and security
on the
(stretcher),
sand,
items
which
require
specific
that
the hoisting
by the
hoist
blocks
-Perform
a hoist functional
check:
0.6 m (2 ft) and then rewind it :
contact
functions
correctly.
-Check
limit.
must be checked
to be performed
DGACApproved:
during
ODerator.
correctly.
the
30-hour
350 B2
SUP.O
99-37
---
operating
Page 3
.
.
-FLIGHT MANUAL
Manual.
Check before
CAUTION:
the fi rst
fl ight
(BFF) , refer
to
Section
SUPPLEMENTSof th
DGACApproved:
IAIBICIDIEIFIGIHI
'
.
.
350 B2
SUP.O
90-37
Page 6
.FLIGHTMANUAL
with
an end-of-travel
microswitch
monitoring
system:
on the electric
-Unwind
-Wind
hoist.
one to two meters.
the cable:
operation,
check that:
GREEN light
is EXTINGUISHED,
RED light
is EXTINGUISHED.
-Maintain
the "Up" order on the hoist operator's
pushbutton:
oDerations :
mechanism.
oDerations :
DGAC
Approved:
IAIBICIDIEIFIGIHI
350 82
SUP.O
90-37
Page4
~--
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
.Check
fliaht
-Place
the emergency
safety pin in place.
-Check
that
engaged.
the
floatation
circuit
~ear
breakers
in
in the
low position,
aft
pins
locked,
baggage compartment
are
aircraft
and
has flown
at low altitude
the cradle
assemblies.
over
the
sea,
wash
the
inflation
.Check
fliaht
that
the pressure
covering
and that
in each compartment
the floats
is 0.300
are clean
to 0.450
bar.
alighting
-After
landing
in
salty
water,
on a muddy field,
wash with
soft
water.
wash with
soft
water.
Parkina
Park
in the
shade,
if
possible,
and protect
the floats
against
the
heat.
optional
equipment requires
daily operating
checks.
the presence
of
qualified
staff
to
perform
that
the pressure
of the cylinders
is correct.
CARGOSWING
-After
the last flight,
at the lock input.
lightly
grease
(G3S4) the
hook
.N
DCACApproved:
350 82
IAIBICIDIEIFIGIHI
SUP.O
90-37
--
PageS
--FLIGHT
.18
MANUAL
eurocopter
FLIGHT
AS
MANUAL
35082
'
.SUPPLEMENT
INSTRUCTIONS
FOROPERATIONIN COLDWEATHER
IMPORTANT NOTE
The information contained herein supplements or supersedes the information given
in the basic flight manual and/or applicable flight manual supplements,
The effectivity of the supplement at the latest revision is specified an the List at
Effective Pages,
*
ThIs supplement
supports the helicopters
delivered
by bath AEROSPATIALE
and EUROCOPTER
FRANCE.
Revisions to this supplement sre made by EUROCOPTER
FRANCE usIng the
same procedures
as AEROSPATIALE.
-~==
Jil
~-='-IQ:
.DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I 0 I ElF
IGI
EUROCOPTER
FRANCE
Direction
Support
Technique
Etablissemenl
-13725
Marignane
35082
da Marignane
Cedex
-France
SUP.4.P1
94-05
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
.LIST
OF APPROVED EFFEmVE
PAGES
DOT CERTIFICATION
(1)
Evolution
page code
-R : Revised,
to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
SUP.
4
4
4
4
4
4
P1
P5
DATE
1
1/01
1
2
3
4.
94-05
94-05
94-05
94-0S
94-05
94-05
.DGAC
Date
89-17
91-{)8
94-{)5
No
Approved:
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
NORMAL REVISION:
DGAC APPROVED
Date
SUP.4.P5
94-05
--
(1)
DATE: 2
35082
DATE
R
R
R
R
R
N
(1)
Page 1
FLIGHTMANUAL
.1~
This supplement details all the procedures to be followed when the aircraft
is used in particular
climatic conditions,
such as cold weather and snow.
Aircraft
servicing does not require any special tools or systematic
replacement.
2
GENERALRECOMMENDATIDNS
For rational operation of the aicraft in cold weather and snow, it
reconmended to carry out the following basic operations:
is
R
R
R
it
is
R
R
R
:
recommended that:.
.either
regular ground runs be carried out every two hours for
temperatures of about -2D'C and every hour for lower temperatures.
.or preheating of the engine, transmission assemblies and cabin be
effected before take-off (althourgh the helicopter
is capable of
carrying out engine start up and rotor spinning at temperatures
down to -4D'C).
During the preheating operation.
carefully wipe out the deicing water to
avoid all water accretion on the aircraft
and water re-icing as soon as
preheating is over, particularly
on the AIR INTAKES and c~onents
located above the air intakes.
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
PRACTICAL ADVICES
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
LUBRICANTS
TO BE USEDFORTRANSMISSION
ASSEMBLIES
Below -25 'C, do not use AIR 3525 (0 155) oil for transmission assemblies
R
without initial
preheating.
The other oils authorized in Section LIMITATIONS of the basic Flight Manual
may be used down to -40 'C without preheating.
NOTE: It should be remembered that when changing the oil, the system is
-first
to be flushed in accordance with the recommendations in the
maintenance publications;
.DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I DIE
I FIG I
350 B2
SUP.4
94-05
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
4 USE
OF
BATTERIES
FOR
STARTING
following
chart.
DOMAINE DE DEMARRAGE
AVECBATTERIE DE 16 AH
STARTING ENVELOPE WITH 16 AH BATTERY
TEK'. EXTrCJ
O.A. T.
f.C)
:\
-~.
-25.
-15.
!MARRAGE
AVEC
BATTER1E
1 BATT",
FROlDE
DlARGEE
E'1CI~
m.D.
START ON
CHARGED
BATTERY
~
!
1CI~
START ON
WARN (20'C).~RGE'D
>
8AT7ERY
2 BATT
!MARRAGE
AVECBATTERIE1 BATT
CHAl (NC) CHARGEE
~
oq
""
2 BATT
"
.'
PREPARATION
FOR FLIGHT
Independently of the inspections
perform the following
operations
R
prescribed in the basic Flight
and inspections:
Manual,
R
R
R
Main rotor
blades
Remove the blade socks, then remove snow if need be and, if necessary
remove ice from blades using hot air flow at a temperature not exceeding
80.C.
R
R
R
R
R
R
Main rotor
the scissors.
and the
Power plant
R
R
R
R
R
R
-Remove the air intake cover and the exhaust nozzle blank after removing
snow from the aircraft
surface.
-Remove snow and ice accretion in the vicinity
of the air intake, on
either side of the screen and inside the engine air intake duct (remove
the air intake screen if necessary).
DGAC
Approved:
IA Ic
I DIE
I F IGI
350B2
R
R
R
R
R
SUP.4.
94-05
Page 2
FLIGHT
.-It
is
irroerative
that
Manually
and
up
to
In
the
of
.remove
stage
be
of
snow
the
clean
and
ice
c~ressor
inside
the
air
intake
duct
ice
using
wipe
.inspect
wooden
the
or
plastic
surface
drains,
Tail
intake
for
icing:
.carefully
static
air
check
first
case
the
visually
MANUAL
scraper,
using
unblanked
cloth
scuppers;
soaked
check
with
for
isopropyl
snow
alcool
and
ice
on
vent
and
ports.
rotor
-Remove
the
pitch
blade
rods..
sockets,
-Manually
remove
ice
from
the
TRH
assentJly
(blades,
rotate
least,
th~n
.).
the
tail
rotor
so
that
the
main
rotor
performs
turn
at
then check:
.the
swashplate
.the
TRH
.the
freewheel
R
rotation
(rotor
brake
not
blocked).
rotatioR,
operation.
Structure
-Remove
the
-Make
cabin
sure
cover
that
once
the
the
windshield
inspection
is
wiper
has
completed.
not
remained
stuck
on
the
canopy
Fliaht
controls
-Enaine
controls
-Before
operating
the
the
controls,
it
is
recOlmlended
to
heat-up
the
inside
of
cabin.
-Operate
the
controls
controls,
progressively,
fuel
complete
flow
then
control
and
operate
collective
the
pitch
rotor
brake
control
over
their
travel.
R
It
is
recommended
rotor
Do
-10
oerform
extensive
travel
of
the
cvclic
and
tail
svstem
bleedina
not
'C
bleed
the
where
valve
the
fuel
system
seals
procedures
given
Approved:
I A I C I DIE
under
prove
ten1)erature
equal
to
or
lower
than
inefficient.
STARTING
All
.DGAC
to
controls.
Fuel
not
I FIG
in
this
basic
manual
remain
applicable.
350 B2
I
SUP.4
94-05
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
7 AFTER
STARTING
.:
When nominal speed is reached with the fuel flow control in the gate, check R
that all warning, caution and advisory lights are off, that pressure
R
readings are O.K. Test the hydraulic accumulators with the collective
lever R
secured at full low pitch. When control loads are felt,
move the stick
R
grip 3-4 cm to evaluate the load, then center the stick (no load) and
R
restore pressure.
R
R
IN CASEOF ENGINEFAILURE
R
Following an engine .failure
at light weight, the stabilized
rotor speed may R
be below the audio warning threshold:
the pilot can switch of the horn
R
using the relevant pushbutton.
R
R
R
9 CHECKAFTER LAST FLIGHT OF THE DAY
R
The operations described in the Basic Normal are to be completed by the
R
following actions:
R
-Observe the general recommendations mentioned above.
R
-When the rotor stops rotating,
place the cyclic pitch stick close to the R
neutral position and the collective
pitch lever secured at full low
R
pitch, with tail rotor blades in the horizontal position.
R
-Inspection
of the engine magnetic plugs should be performed within 30 mn R
after the rotor has stopped rotating,
in order to avoid seal damaging.
R
-Care must be taken not to leave doors open.
R
-Install
the air intake cover and exhaust nozzle blank.
R
-When the aircraft
is parked in an unsheltered area it is recommendedto
R
apply anti-icing
materials and to carry our the aircraft
parking and
R
mooring.
R
EOUIPMENT
ITEMS
All the aircraft
equipment items allow flying in cold weather conditions
except spherical thrust bearing PIN 704A 33.633.109 which must not be used
at temperatures below -25 'C.
N
DGACApproved:
IA I C I DIE I F I C I
350 B2
SUP.48
94-05
Page 4
FLIGHT MANUAL
.18
eurocopter
FLIGHT
AS
MANUAL
350
82
.SUPPLEMENT
Per drawings:
.
-I
350A 82.8014
350A 82.8015
IMPORTANT
NOTE
The information contained herein supplements or supersedes the information given
in the basic flight manual and/or applicable flight manual supplements.
The effectivity of the supplement at the latest revision is specified on the list of
Effective Pages.
This supplement
supports the helicopters
delivered by both AEROSPATIALE
and EUROCOPTER
FRANCE.
Revisions to this supplement
are made by EUROCOPTER
FRANCE using the
same procedures
as AEROSPATIALE.
THIS SUPPLEMENT
MUST BE INCLUDED IN THE FLIGHT MANUAL WHEN THE
EQUIPMENT MENTIONED ABOVE IS INSTALLED ON THE AIRCRAFT.
-~
=:::...JId
~=---=q
.DGAC
Approved:
IAICIDIEIFlclHI
EUROCOPTER
FRANCE
Etablissement
de Marignane
35082
SUP.
94-01
11.P1
Pagel,
.
.
.FLIGHT
MANUAL
LIST OF APPROVED
EFFECTIVEPAGES
DOT CERTIFICATION
(1)
Evolution
page code
-R : Revised,
to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
SUP.ll
SUP. 11
SUP.l1
SUP.l1
SUP.l1
SUP.l1
SUP.l1
P1
P5
DATE
1
1/01
1
2
3
4
5
94-01
94-01
94-01
94-01
94-01
94-01
94-01
NORMAL REVISION:
APPROVED REVISIONS
.DGAC
Date
89-17
94-01
Approved:
w
No
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
DATE
(1)
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
No
(1)
DGAC APPROVED
Date
DATE: 0
35082
SUP
94-01
.11.P5
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
.1~
The "CARGO
SWING" external load carrying installation
is composed of :
-A suspended pyramid frame (3) designed to reduce swinging of the load,
equipped with a release unit (4). The release unit hook can be opened
electrically
in normal operation and mechanically in emergency
conditions.
-A control and indicating system, for the pilot,
comprising:
.load indicator (1), on the instrument panel, with a zero setting
control (2) ;
an electrical
system supplying power to the normal release circuit
via
a pushbutton, on the control console and a switch on the pilot's
cyclic
stick grip;
.an "EMERGENCY
RELEASE"(jettison)
control handle mounted on the
underside of the collective
lever.
The load indicator electrical
circuit
is protected by a fuse and the
normal release hook control circuit
by two fuses.
2;
2 LIMITATIONS
EXTERNAL LOAD OPERATIONS MUST BE IN ACCORDANCEWITH OPERATING
REGULATIONS
GOVERNING
THESEOPERATIONS.
.
The limitations
but are c~leted
laid
down in the
by the following
basic Flight
limitations.
Manual
remair)
applicable
R
R
-Maximum load
The maximumpermissible slung load is 1160 kg (2S57 lb).
-Maximum Qross weiQht with external load
Maximumpermissible gross weight with an external load is that at which
hover O.G.E. can be held. (See Section of the basic Flight Manual).
Maximumweight including
CAUTION:
-LIMITED
external
load:
FLIGHT MANUAL.
.DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I D IE I FIG I H I
350 B2
SUP
94-01
.11
Page 1
--FLIGHT
MANUAL
-LonQitudinal
C.Q.
limits
Use chart
weights.
below to define
longitudinal
c.g.
"":CENTRAGE
(m)""
1750 .;..;.
'.".'
.:...
.'.'.
.'.
.'.'.
1400 .'.'.
'.
:.::..
1200.' ..'
"j:!!!!~~~ .
LIMITE ARRIERE
REARWARD LlM
1600
LIMITE AVANT
FORWARD LIMIT
.j.
...'..
s
~
124
5512
'.'.':.:'::.:':':
i ':~~
!!~::':::::.'
S
.;
with respect to
r3:ffi 13.21l
L1.4253.44
3~
3.15 3.20
3.30
3.35
3.40
3.45
~::~:~
:~:.~:
~:::~::~:
::::,.:~~~~..~.~~~~:~.:~~~~~~~:.:.
'...~::::
::::: ::: ::~::~
:::
<
2
limits
.' .'.
12E
130
124.811126.411128 I"
132
CG (in)
134
I'
136
38
1137.4137.8
~
Absolute
(148
km/h
maximumpennissible
-92
Particular
care
on the sling.
tlm
MPH).
must be exercised
when bulky
loads
DGAC
Approved:
I A I c I DIE I FIG I
are be.ing
the limit
carried
speed
35082 SUP.11
.
94-01
Page 2
---FLIGHT
.-Instruction
MANUAL
Dlates
.An
instruction
R
plate
in
the
cockpit
indicates:
.A
.
.
plate,
visible
hook, indicates
and located
near to the
R
R
EMERGENCYPROCEDURES
The emergency procedures
laid
applicable
but are completed
Enaine failure
load
with external
remain
R
R
-If
an engine failure
should
occur in flight
with an external
load,
establish
auto rotational
flight
and immediately
release
the load.
-If
engine failure
occurs whilst
ground personnel
are hooking up the load,
the pilot
should move away to the right,
applying
collective
pitch
to
hold the aircraft
up. Ground personnel
are to be forewarned
that in
the event of engine failure
they are to move away to the left.
DGACAPpraved:
I A I C I DIE
I FIG
350B2
I H I
SUP.11
94-01
Page 3
L__-
FLIGHT MANUAL
4 NORMAL
PROCEDURES
The procedures laid down in the basic Flight Manual remain applicable
but are c~leted
by the following procedures.
R
R
of the installation
operation:
-~
.When the load is secured, apply collective
pitch very smoothly,
while maintaining the aircraft
directly
above the load. Whenthe cables
are taut, dwell briefly
before raising the load.
.Lift
the load off the ground vertically,
keeping a watch on the load
indicator,
then move off in a forward climb.
-Manoeuvres
All control movements should be made very gently, with very gradual
acceleration
and deceleration,
and only slightly
banked turns.
DGACApproved:
3S0 B2
SUP.11
I A I C I 0 I ElF IG I H I
94-01
---
Page 4
.
.
FLIGHTMANUAL
[=~~~~~J
Paragraph 4
.In
NORMAL
PROCEDURE
after:
modes"
added as follows:
of the retaining
operation
of
.
8
.
350 82
SUP.II
DGAC Approved:
I AI
C I DIE
I FIG
I H I
98-43
---~
Page 4
*RR*L
---FLIGHT
MANUAL
.-~
Establish zero translational
ground speed sufficiently
high to ensure
that the load is not dragged along the ground, then descend vertically
until
the load is deposited. The load indicator
reading is zero.
-~
To release the load, actuate the switch on the cyclic
Check that the load is effectively
If
5
.The
stick.
released.
R
handle to release it.
PERFORMANCE
Perfonnance Data given in the basic Flight
Manual apply.
.
.DGAC
Approved:
IAlclDIEIFIGIHI
35082
SUP.11
94-01
Page 5
I
FLIGHT MANUAL
.'8
eurocopter
FLIG HT MAN UAL
AS 350
82
.SUPPLEMENT
EXTERNAL
LOADTRANSPORT
"CARGOSLING"
Per drawings:
IMPORTANT
350A 82.8012
350A 82.8013
NOTE
..
This supplement
supports the helicopters delivered by both AEROSPATIALE
end EUROCOPTER
FRANCE.
Revisions to this supplement
are made by EUROCOPTER
FRANCE using the
seme procedures
as AEROSPATIALE.
THIS SUPPLEMENT
MUST BE INCLUDED IN THE FLIGHT MANUAL WHEN THE
EQUIPMENT MENTIONED ABOVE IS INSTALLED ON THE AIRCRAFT.
-~;:::::
JJd
~~
.DGAC
EUROCOPTER
FRANCE
Approved:
I A I C I 0 I ElF
Etablissement
-13725
350 82
I GI HI
de Marignene
Marlgnane Cede.
-France
SUP.12.P1
94-01
Page 1
.
.
-FLIGHT
MANUAL
LIST OF APPROVED
EFFECTIVEPAGES
DOT CERTIFICATION
(1)
Evolution
page code
-R : Revised,
to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
SUP.12
SUP.12
SUP.12
SUP.12
SUP.12
SUP.12
P1
P5
DATE
1
1/01
1
2
3
4
(1
94-01
94-01
94-01
94-01
94-01
94-01
.DGAC
Date
0
1
89-17
94-()1
Approved:
W
No
DATE
(1)
R
R
R
R
R
R
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
Date
NORMAL REVISION: 1
DGACAPPROVED
DATE: 03
35082
SUP.12.P5
94-01
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
.1~
The external
load-carrying
installation
includes:
-A
release
electrical
hook control
circuit
circuit
is protected
R
R
by tWo fuses.
1
R
g
IJ
~
2 LIMITATIONS
The limitations
laid down in the basic Flight
are completed by the following limitations.
-Maximum
but
load
The maximumpermissible
sling
load
.DGAC
load:
Approved:
I A I C 101 ElF
external
350 B2
I G I HI
SUP.12
94-01
Page 1
R
R
-FLIGHT
MANUAL
-LonQitudinal
C.Q.
limits
Use graph below to define
weights.
longitudinal
c.g.
limits
with respect to
-;;
;e-
;;;
I-
co
co
I,I~~~ AR~'ER~
REARWARDLlM
:..:..
.,;
g
g
,;
~
-Y.,J!.,!.,.
Absolute maximumpermissible
speed with a load on the hook is 80 knots
(92 MPH) (148 km/h).
Particular
care must be exercised when bulky loads are being carried
on the sling.
~
DGAC
Approved:
I AI CI DIEI FIGI
the limit
35082
speed according
SUP.12 .
94-01 Page
2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.-Instruction
olates
.An
instruction
plate
in
the
cockpit
indicates:
4It
plate,
visible
hook, indicates
to
the
and located
near
to
EnQine
-If
-If
R
R
remain
R
R
EMERGENCYPROCEDURES
The emergency procedures
laid
down in the basic Flight
Manual
applicable
but are calf)leted
by the following
procedures.
the
failure
with
external
load
an engine failure
should occur in flight
with an external
load,
establish
autorotational
flight
and immediately
release the load.
engine failure
occurs whilst
ground personnel
are hooking
up the load,
the pilot
should move away to the right,
applying
collective
pitch
to
hold the aircraft
up. Ground personnel
are to be forewarned
that in
the event of engine failure
they are to move away to the left.
NORMAL PROCEDURES
The procedures
laid
down in the basic Flight
Manual
but are completed
by the following
procedures.
remain
applicable
R
R
Carrying
heavy loads is a delicate
operation.
due to the possible
effects
of a swinging
load on the flight
behaviour
of the helicopter.
Consequently,
pilots
are advised to train
with gradually
increased
sling
loads before
undertaking
heavy load carrying
operations.
WARNING:
4It
DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I DIE
I F IG I H I
350B2
SUP. 12
94-01
Page 3
-FLIGHT
MANUAL
-Takeoff
-:-whenthe load is secured, apply collective
pitch very smoothly, while
maintaining the aircraft
directly
above the load. Whenthe cables are
taut, dwell briefly
before raising the load.
.Lift
the load off the ground vertically,
keeping a watch on the load
indicator,
then move off in a forward climb.
-Manoeuvres
All control
acceleration
movements should
and deceleration,
R
R
R
-~
-Release
TOre1ease the load, actuate the switch on the cyclic
Check that the load is effectivelv
released.
stick
grip.
R
R
R
If
5
actuate
the jettison
PERFORMANCE
The performance curves for weights in excess of 4961lb (2250 kg) are
plotted in dotted line on the performance charts contained in the
PERFORMANCE
Section of the basic Flight Manual.
DGAC
Approved:
IAICIDIEIFIGIHI
35082SUP.12
.
94-01
Page 4
FLIGHT MANUAL
.~='Y
5&
IfILO~IJ111r MIAIMIlJJIAIL.
IA$
~~(Q1
[m:?2
.$ll1JlFlFlLlE~IEOO1'
SLIDING DOOR
350A 82.2081.01
82.2000.01
IMPORTANT
NOTE
-~~=]/7
~=~IVISION
DGACApproved:
aerospaIfd8
SOCIETENATION
ALE INDUSTRIELLE
HELICOPTERES-OIRECTION
SUPPORTCLIENTS -B.P.17~
350 82
-13723
-HARIGNAIE
SUP
89-17
---
FRANCE
.13.P1
Page1
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
PAGE
INTENTIONALLY
LEFT
BLANK
.
DGAC
Approved:
[I]
350B2
SUP .13.Pl
.
89-17 Page
2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.CUSTOMIZATION
A/C:
350 82
-SIN:
LIST OF ADDITIONALAPPROVED
PAGES
SECTION
..
PAGE
DATE CODE
SECTION
PAGE
DATE CODE
LIST OF ne LATEST~
Nf'R(NED REVISla-IS
No
Date
89-17
No
~
REVISla-I : 0
~
I!l'PRO\lO
DATE
Date
':I"'~
.DGAC
Approved:
~
350 B2
SUP .13.Pl
89-17
Page3
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF CONOITIONAL
REVISIONS(RC)
This manual assigned to the helicopter
mentioned on the
contains
the following
pink pages except those cancelled
conditions
are complied with.
title
page.
when the
CAUTION
IF A NORMAL
REVISION(RN) MODIFIESTHE PAGENUMBER
FOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNEDBELOW. THE READER WILL HAVE TO CHANGETHE NUMBEROF THE PINK
PAGE BY HAND. SO THAT THE INFORMATION REMAINS IN ACCORDANCEWITH THE
PARAGRAPHCONCERNED.
.Section
Page
Date
Applicable
before condition
is met:
.
OOTE : The date
-followed
.DGAC
Approved:
[I]
of the last
week in this
two figures
year.
350 B2
of the
SUP
89-17
year
.13.P3
Page 1
FLI GHTMArIJAL
COMPOSITION
OF RUSHREVISIONS(RR)
The Manual contains
No
SECTION
the following
-PAGE
additional
CODE
No
yellow pagels) :
SECTION -PAGE
CODE
DATE
DGACApproved:
~
1111111111-
DATE
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.13.P4
Page 1
-C
--FLIGHT
MAMJAL
.LIST
OF APPROVED
EFFECTIVE
PAGES
(1)
Evolution
-R
-N
page code
: Revised.
: New. to
SECTION
13. 0
13. 0
13.0
13.0
13.0
13. 0
13. 0
13. 0
13. 0
to be replaced
be inserted
PAGE
P1
P1
P1
P3
P4
P5
DATE (1
1
2
3
1
1
1/ 1 -011
2
3
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
Date
89-17
tJ
PAGE
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LIST OF THELATEST~
N'PR().,DREVISI~
tJ
SECTION
DATE (1
~
REVISIOO: 0
OOACU'PROI,.D
DATE
Date
""ON
DGACApproved:
m
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.13.P5
Page 1
*01-
FLIGHT MANUAL
.1~
The aircraft
can be fitted with one or two sliding door installations.
These installations
are of same design and synwnetrical.
Each installation
mainly comprises:
-A small. jettisonable
forward door (1). providing access to the pilot's
or copilot's
seat.
-A large. sliding.
rear door (2). running on three guide rails.
This door is fitted with:
.an open position catch (3) (door held fully open)
.an inner control lever (4) connected to the outer handle (5) for
opening and closing the door
.a closing system locking lever (6).
These sliding doors can be opened in flight
by the crelolnembersfor rescue
hoisting operations. and on ground to facilitate
freight loading.
.or
.DGAC
Approved:
[fJ
350 82
SUP .13
89-17
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
---~~
2LIMITATIONS .
2.1
Aircraft
~1ae
Fitted
with L.H.
Sliding
Door
CLOSED
L.H.
CLOSED
Sliding
VNE
Fitted
with
R.H.
Sliding
70 kt
110 kts::
204 km/hr
80 kts -14B
km/hr
Door and two Standard
km/hr/Bl
-127
-92
MPH)
MPH
MPH
DOO~S on L.H.
OPEN OR RE~VED
VNE
PROHIBITED
door
operation:
fitted
with
-Opening:
-Closing:
both L.H.
70 kt
60 kts
60 kts
and R.H.
sliding
-111
-111
MPH
(130 km/hr/B1
km/hr
km/hr
-69
-69
MPH)
MPH
MPH
doors
--CLOSED
L.H.
(130
DOORS
RE~VED
Aircraft
MPH)
CLOSED
CLOSED
Sliding
PROHIBITED
-Opening:
-Closing:
SLIDING
DOOR
80TH L.H.
2.3
RE~VED
door operation:
Aircraft
Side
R.H.
on R.H.
SLIDING
DOOR
OPEN OR RE~VED
2.2
Doors
OPEN OR RE~VED
SLIDING
DOOR
CLOSED
VNE
OPEN OR RE~VED
60 kt (111
Sliding
door operation:
-Opening,
60 kts -111
-Closing:
60 kts -111
km/hr
km/hr
km/hr/69
-69
-69
MPH)
MPH
MPH
MPH
MPH
DGAC Approved:
[]
is
lower.
350 B2
SUP
B9-17
.13
Page 2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.3
EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
If necessary.
can be jettisoned.
4 OORMAL
PROCEDURES
squabs
becoming
detached
at airspeed
above 70 knots
of the rear
(139 krn/h-81
MPH);
in these conditions.
PERFORMANCE
Performance data as given in Section 5.1 of the Flight Manual applies
equally to the helicopter fitted
with sliding door installation(sJ
in
closed position.
.
~
DGAC Approved:
350 82
SUP
89-17
.13
Page 3
I
FLIGHT MANUAL
8 eurocopter
FLIGHT
AS
MANUAL
350
82
.SUPPLEMENT
SANDFILTER
Optional:
IMPORTANT
OP 1536
NOTE
This supplement
supports
the helicopters
delivered
by both AEROSPATIALE
and EUROCOPTER
FRANCE.
Revisions
to this supplement
are made by EUROCOPTER
FRANCE using the
same procedures
as AEROSPATIALE.
THIS SUPPLEMENT
MUST BE INCLUDED IN THE FLIGHT MANUAL WHEN
EQUIPMENT MENTIONED
ABOVE IS INSTALLED ON THE AIRCRAFT.
-~~..I!d
~~
.DGAC
EUROCOPTER
FRANCE
Etablissament
THE
de Marignane
APproved:
I A I B I C I DI
350 B2
SUP.14.P1
92-44
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
AS 35082
SUPPLEMENT
14
B
Subiect : Additional
conditions.
Either
protection
of the following
installations
is used:
or
8
DGACAPproved:
W
350 82
SUP.
92-04
14.P1
Page 1
"'82'"
FLIGHT MANUAL
.CUSTOMIZATION
:
A/C:
350 B2
-SIN:
LIST OF ADDITIONALAPPROVED
PAGES
SECTION
PAGE
DATECODE
SECTION
PAGE
DATECODE
REQUIRINGTHE CUSTOMIZATION
OF THE FLIGHT MANUAL
ON
GREENPAGES.
LIST OF nE LATEST~
APPROI,D
REVISIONS
r-b
.DGAC
Date
Date
89-17
Approved:
[g
No
NORMAL
REVISION: 0
~
~IIED
DATE
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.14.P1
Page 3
---
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
CONDITIONALREVISIONS(RC)
.OF
Page
Date
Applicable
before condition
is ~et '.
.
NOTE: The date is coded and consists of the last two figures
-followed
by the number of the week in this year.
DGACApproved:
GJ
350 82
of the year
SUP
89-17
.14.P3
Page 1
,
FLIGHT MANUAL
C~POSITION
OF RUSHREVISIONS (RR)
No
SECTION
lA
SUP.14.Pl
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
the
-PAGE
1
1
2
4
following
additional
CODE
DATE
No
yellow
page(s)
SECTION ~ PAGE
CODE
DATE
92-04
92-04
92-04
92-04
..,-
.
'
DGACApproved:
350 82
SUP.
92-04
14.P4
Page 1
*82*
;!
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF RUSHREVISIONS(RR)
The Manual contains
No
the following
SECTION -PAGE
additional
CODE
DATE
No
yellow page(s) :
SECTION-PAGE
CODE
DATE
..
.
.DGAC
Appr-oved:
[]
350 82
SUP
89-17
.14.P4
Page 1
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
LIST OF APPROVED
EFFECTIVE PAGES
DOT CERTIFICATION
(1)
Evolution
page code
-R : Revised,
to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SUPPLEMENT
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
SUP.14
P1
P5
PAGE
DA~
(1)
1
1/01
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
92-44
92-44
92-44
92-44
89-17
92-44
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
R
R
R
R
.DGAC
89-17
92-44
Approved:
W
SUPPLEMENT
PAGE
DATE
NORMAL REVISION: 1
DGACAPPROVED
DATE: 26 -JUIL. 1993
35082
SUP.14.P5
92-44
.I
(1,)
Page 1
I
FLIGHT MANUAL
is also designed to
of snow in flight,
under
function
.
8
DGAC
Approved:
35082
OJ
SUP.14
92-04
~-
Page 1
"B2"
FLIGHT
MANUAL
B
Complete paragraph NORMAL
PROCEDURES
as follows:
Pre-fliaht
checks
and particularly
.
DGACApproved:
CO
35082
SUP.14
92-04
Page 2
*82*
.
FLIGHTMANUAL
B
Subiect : Flight
under falling
snow
snow,
.
..0
.
.
DGAC
Approved:
m
35082
SU P. 14!
92-46
Page 1
*82*l
"
l~
The sand filter
installation
is designed to protect the engine against
ingestion of sand.
R
This installation
even when it does not use any P2 bleed air, is also
R
designed to protect the air intake against any potential
induction of snow R
in flight,
in falling
snow.
R
The system mainly consists of the following:
-a filter
fitted
on the engine air intake, below the ice protection
screen,
-a P2 air pressure supply system,
-an electric
control and monitoring system.
During
engine operation.
constitute
the filter.
intake.
the ambient
The filtered
air flows
through
separator
tubes which
air
is forced
towards
the engine
air
by P2 air.
The electrical
circuit
supplies an electric
valve via the "SANDFILT" pushbutton.
Opening and closing of the P2 air pressure circuit
is controlled
by the electric
valve. A blue SANDF. light comes on to indicate that the
electric
valve is fully open. The electrical
circuit
is protected by the
SANDFILT. fuse on the side panel.
2
LIMITATIONS
The limitations
laid down in the basic Flight Manual remain applicable
with the exception of the following
specific limitations:
R
R
-The flight
-Sand filter
R
R
envelope restrictions
operating.
.the
heating and demisting
.cDn1Jly with the following
O.A.T.
C'O
Ng. diff.
at
MAX T /0
PWR
Ng. diff.
at
MAX. CONTINUOUS
PWR
.OGAC
Approved:
I AI BI CI D I
-3.5
LOWERTHAN
+ S.C
0
in case of falling
BETWEEN
+ 5'C
AND + 3S.C
HIGHERTHAN
+ 3S'C
-0.5
-1
-4
-4.5
350 B2
SUP.14
92-44
Page 1
",
'"
EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
All the emergency procedures specified
in the basic Flight Manual remain
applicable.
If the P2 air valve fails to open (light
remains off),
avoid flying
the
helicopter
in sand-laden atmosphere to prevent premature damage to the
engine.
Should the valve fail to close (light
remains on), flight
can be continued
without adverse consequence.
FLIGHTMANUAL
NORMALPROCEDURES
The nonnal procedures laid down in the basic Flight Manual remain
applicable
but are completed by the following procedures.
EXTERNAL
CHECKS
-Engine
air intake.
R
R
R
R
and particularly
CHECKSBEFORESTARTINGTHE ENGINE
-Test
the indicator
light
located
R
on the instrument
panel.
ENGINE POWERCHECK
When checking the engine, make sure that the sand filter
pushbutton
set to "off".
When the sand filter
is fitted,
use the power assurance check chart
the next page (Figure 1).
The procedures for checks on ground and in flight,
given in Section
remain applicable.
FLYING
IN
SAND-LADEN
is
on
4,
An.10SPHERE
-Switch
off the heating and de-misting systems.
-Depress
the SANDFILTER pushbutton.
-Make sure the SANDFILTER light illuminates.
Nlli
DGAC
Approved:
I A I BI CI DI
causes t4 temperature
350B2
to
rise
by
SUP.14.
92-44
Page 2
.
\
FLIGHT MANUAL
.(.~:
..'.'.'.
'.'
'.
'.
...'...'.
'
'...'.
'..
'
::;:-:-.;:::::.:;:;':;::;;;:::::::'.:.
:::::::::::~:
'::.:;::::::::::;::::::::::;::::::::i:...:::
.."..
~
"""""'"
~ 10
."""""'"
'.
'.'
""""""
...'.'.
'...
'
"
...
...'...
l-
OJ
.: 0
~
~
-10
.-20
'"'::::::::::::~;.~.:ii:.::
-30
(FTX100)
(MXIOO)
.100
30
IoJ
.;
'"
f
"
oi 50
OJ
~
.10
IoJ
400
(tr/.,)
.~
.,
.,
.Z
.,0
"~
300a;
380
COUPLE TOROuE (%)
DGACApproved:
I A I 8 Ic I D I F I c I H I
Filter
Not Operating
35082
SUP.14
89-17
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
5 PERFORMANCE
5.1
ReQulatorv PerformanceData
The performance data laid down in the basic Flight Manual Section 5.1
remain applicable with the exception of the following data:
5.1.1
Sand Filter
not ODeratinQ
FLIGHT
HEATING AN DEMISTING
HEATINGAND/OR
R
R
CONFIGURATION
SYSTEMS
OFF
DEMISTING
SYSTEMS
OPERATING
R
R
Figure 2
(Fig.2) minus 60 kg
~.
O.G.E hover
Figure
(130 lb)
(Fig.3) minus 60 kg
(130 lb)
R
R
R
Rate of clim
Figure
(Fig.5)
I.G.E hover
5.1.2
Sand Filter
ODeratinQ
OUTSIDEAIR TEMPERATURE('C)
LOWERTHAN
BETWEEN
+ 5.C AND
+ 5'C
HIGHER THAN
+ 35'C
+ 35'C
IGE hover
Figure 2
(fig.2)
minus 40kg
(90lb)
(fig.2)
minus 100kg
(220lb)
OGE hover
Figure
(fig.3)
(fig.3)
Rate of clim
Figure
(fig.5)
minus 40kg
(90lb)
minus 100kg
(220lb)
DGAC
Approved:
I A I BI C I DI
350
B2
minus 180ft/mn
SUP.14
.
92-44
Page4
C{""
',~
:.:,;
FLIGHT MANUAL
B
Paragraph 5.1.1 is to be modified as follows:
The .Sand Filter
table below:
FLIGHT
CONFIGURATION
Not Operating.
HEATING AN DEMISTING
SYSTEMSOFF
HEATING AND/OR
DEMISTING SYSTEMS
OPERATING
I.G.E.
hover
Figure 2
O.G.E. hover
Figure 3
Rate-of-climb
Figure 5
(Fig.2) minus 60 kg
(130 lb)
(Fig.3) minus 60 kg
(130 lb)
(Fig.5)
.
DGACApproved:
350 82
SUP
92-04
.14
Page4
*82*
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
BLANK PAGE
.
.DGAC
Approved:
IAIBICIDIFIGIHI
350 B2
SUP.14
89-17
PageS
'"
;~J
2000:mt
~
'i
'
'I
i !I
"
~fJ {
00
6000
18000.
..E
~
.-
~ 16000
~
.~
5000
.a;
I-
5
U)
UJ
It:
~ 14000
U!
i
~
U)
~ 12000
I-
a-
;r
a:
~
'"
'"'
10000
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
4000
aU!
c
~
;?
3000
8000
2000
6000
~
4000
1000
I)
0
0
2000
'"
0
"'
0
:-
.0
-1000
-305
30~~
1500
2000
' .~5~~
MASSEWEIGHT
Figure
2250
(kg)
2500
~
2
CONDITIONS
-Height:
5 ft
-1.5
-Sand
filter
not operating
-Heating
and demisting
systems
DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I D I FIG
I HI
off
35D
82
SUP.14
.
89-17
Page 6---
FLIGHT MANUAL
.20000
6000
18000
..e
'I-
5000
.CJ)
I-
+...
I-
16000
:J
CJ)
UJ
Q:
14000
.~
UJ
a.
"
4000
(t:
~
:J
:J
l-
12000
UJ
I-
(t:
-I
0.
<t
~
10000
.~
3000
C\
1'\
8000
2000
6000
4000
1000
2000
0
~
0
<5
-1000
-305
1500
3010~
2000
..35~~
'
.~010~
..~5100
2250
(kg)
5b'oo
'
.,
MASSEWEIGHT
2500
(lb
~ \
~
)"Jf L
Figure
CONDITIONS
-No
wind
OG
-Heating
and
-Sand
demisting
filter
.DGAC
systems
not
18
HOVER
PERFORMANCE
operating
Approved:
IE
E
off
35082
FIG
SUP.14
89-17
Page
FLIGHT MANUAL
33
,
..
.
.
, ,
---ii
..
g
i:
~.:'
'
i ;
-00
-30
-20
-10
~.EXT.
10
20
30
40
50
60
1500
I O.A.T. c.C'
with
internal
DGAC
Approved:
I A I B I C I D I FIG
I HI
2500
3000
so
HAOOE
COMIE I C(NIIeCTED
I[CJjT
Figure
NOTE:
weight
limitation
2250 kg (4961 lb)
2000
load:
4
CORRECTED WEIGHT TO
DETERMINE RATES OF CLIMB
(on Figure
opposite)
350
B2
SUP
.14.
89-17
Page 8
FLIGHT MANUAL
..,
,
,.
, .
...,..
...
, .
...,
.
,.
..,.
~-i;....tt.~..!
::
::
.I.f.
..,
f : : i
i ! ;; ;:: i
: : 1 ~ i: ~:
1-..1.''.:..,oj.
'.t. -1.'1-.r..:1..:.
-f...'i.. i
i:
:i
,.
i::!
~:: i
-1--1..
1-.i..i.j.'
--f..i..t'
-40-30-20-10
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 0
TEMP.EXT. I O.A. T.
I'C)
::::
.-,j-- '+-'f'.f..~.
0..]..1-,
mt
~
VI~
1000
1:iX)
~
ASC. I RATE"
(F a.ve
2500
1ft/on)
Figure 5
CONDITIONS
-Max.
continuous power rating
-IAS 55 kt -102 km/hr
-Sand filter
not operating
.DGAC
Approved:
I A I B I C I D I FIG I HI
RATEOF CLIMB I
I
35082
SUP.14
89-17
Page 9
.8
eurocopter
FLIGHT
MANUAL
.AS
350 82
SUPPLEMENT
THREE-AXIS
Per drawings:
350A 82.7025.
350A 82.7026.
IMPORTANT
NOTE
The informetion contained herein supplements or supersedes the information given
In the basic flight manual and/or applicable flight manual supplaments.
The effectivity of the supplement at the latest revision is specified on the List of
Effective Pages.
*
ThIs supplement supports the helicopters delivered by both AEROSPATIALE
and EUROCOPTER
FRANCE.
Revisions to this supplement are made by EUROCOPTER FRANCE using the
same proceduras
as AEROSPATIALE.
THIS SUPPLEMENT MUST BE INCLUDED IN THE FLIGHT MANUAL WHEN THE
EQUIPMENT MENTIONED ABOVE IS INSTALLED ON THE AIRCRAFT.
'
-~===.J)/J
EUROCOPTER
~~~
Direction
FRANCE
Technique
OGAC
Approved:
I A I C I FIG
Support
I.
35082
SUP.16.P1
Etablissement
-13725
Marignane
de
Marlgnane
Codex
95-09
-Fronce
Page 1
.FLIGHT
MANUAL
LIST OF APPROVED
EFFECTIVEPAGES
DOTCERTIFICATION
(1) Page Revision Code
-R : Revised, to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SUPPLEMENT
PAGE
DATE (1)
SUP.16
P1
95-09
SUP.16
SUP.16
SUP.16
SUP.16
SUP.16
P5
1/01
1
2
3
4
95-41
95-41
95-41
95-41
95-09
N
R
R
R
95-41
95-41
95-41
95-41
95-41
95-41
95-41
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
SUP.16
SUP.16
SUP.16
SUP.16
SUP.16
SUP.16
SUP.16
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Date
89-17
1
2
95-{)9I
95-41
No
SUPPLEMENTPAGE
NORMAL REVISION:
DGAC APPROVEDI
DATE (1)
Date
.DGAC
APproved:
W
35082
SUP.16.P5
95-41
Page 1
lI
.
.FLIGHT
MANUAL
1~
The three-axis (pitch, roll, yaw) autopilot
attitudes and heading selected by the pilot.
Additional modes can provide:
.
I
II
-airspeed
-altitude
-acquire
hold,
hold,
and hold of heading selected on the HSI.
of :
on copilot's
.vertical
gyro,
.horizontal
situation indicator (HSI),
.gyro-co""ass,
.air
data sensor,
.control
pedal displacement detector,
.lateral
accelerometer.
-An artificial
load release system.
-A control for adjustment of the rudder pedals friction.
-Three control actuators (one per axis).
-Two trim actuators (on pitch and roll axes).
-Three galvanometers (pitch, roll, yaw).
-Three "disengaged channel" indicating lights (P, Rand Y).
-An AP coupler monitoring panel.
-A failure monitoring unit.
This module monitors the operation of the pitch and roll channels at
different
levels by co""aring the data delivered from the instrument
panel vertical gyro and gyro horizon:
.Attitude
sensors.
.Command inputs generating system.
.Control actuators.
In case of abnormal operation, this unit warns the pilot and cuts outI
the defective channel. It starts operating automatically as the AP
pitch and roll channels are engaged.
R,
.DGAC
Approved:
I A I c I FIG I
35082
SUP.16
95-41
Page 1
FLIGHT
MANUAL
GIS
i
~
NAV
ITEM
B/C
[8J.
F/C
Description
No.
V/L
CPL
Yawchannel engagepushbutton
-Function
DGACAPproved:
IA I C I FIG I
35082
SUP.16
95-41
Page2
.
.
.FLIGHT
MANUAL
1.2
Instrument
Panel
Galvanometers
(Figure
The galvanometers
indicate
the position
with respect
to their
middle position;
the pointer
is in the middle.
In pitch
recentered
automatically.
.~
~~
~
CJ4
CJ4
CJ4
Figure
Item
No.
Description
P (pitch)
Direction
galvanometer
R (roll)
Y (yaw)
AnDer indicator
1.3
galvanometer
lights
Cyclic
Stick
Grio
of
Indication
Indicates
a nose-down order given
by the autopilot
Indicates
a roll-to-right
order
given by the autopilot
Indicates
a yaw-to-left
order given
bv the autooilot
When on, the associated
channel(s)
is (are)
not enaaaed
galvanometer
pointer
direction
is
recentered
by moving
shown by the pointer.
the
Controls
The autopilot
controls
grips
(if dual controls
are located
installed)
on pilot's
:!
and copilot's
cyclic
stick
-A
four-way
beep-trim
button.
Allows the pilot
to operate
the stick
andI
change the aircraft
attitudes.
-A trim release pushbutton.
Momentarily
releases
pitch
and roll
channel
artificial
feel loads.
-A pushbutton.
Disengages AP system.
1.4
Vertical
Gvro Valid
Data
Liaht
(If
installed)
.DGAC
R
R
R
R
NOSE UP
of the series-mounted
actuators
when the actuator
is centered.
and roll,
the actuators
are
G00
ABRER
2)
Approved:
I A ICI F I
35082
to
SUP.16
95-41
Page 3
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
FLIGHT MANUAL
5 AUTOPILOTCONTROL
PUSHBUTTONS
(Fi gure 3)
-On
the instrwnent
PITCH
TRIM
ACTUATffi
ROLL
~o
TRIM
ACTUATffi
-On
;~
TRIM
ELEASE
ITEM
No.
1
Descriotion
Pitch trim actuator
-Function
release
release
loads in
the console
inverter
6 AUTOPILOTMONITORING
PANEL(Figure 4)
2
~O
0
0
:g
ITEN
o.
,-. ..
No.
Descr~~10n -Funct10n
1
A.P. warning light (blinking,
red)
2
TRIM caution light (blinking,
amber)
3
Light dimmer
4
TEST function indicator light
5
TEST selector switch
6
Selected heading hold mode engagement advisory light (green)
7
Altitude hold mode engagementadvisory light (green)
8
Airspeed hold mode engagementadvisory light (green)
9
GYROwarni no 1 i oht (ambei:L
DGACApproved:
I A I C I FIG I
35082
SUP.i6.
95-09
--
Page 4
.,
-II
.FLIGHT
LIMITATIONS
Apart from the specific limitations
given below, all
down in Section 2 remain applicable:
the limitations
laid
All
emergency
remain
procedures
applicable,
specified
together
with
in
the
Section
3 of
following
the
additional
basic
Flight
Manual
procedures;
3.1 ~
If jerks or sudden movements independent of air turbulence are felt
during flight with autopilot engaged, this may be caused by the
autopilot.
Consequently disengage the autopilot:
-If
Failure
of hydraulic
system
Failure
of the vertical
INDICATION
-AP light blinks for
10 sec. (Fig. 4).
-Gyro light illuminate
or gyro horizon flag
comes into view.
-P,
R, MONIT pushbuttor
lights on AP control
panel go out (Fig. 1)
-P and R lights (below,
galvanometers)
illuminate (Fig. 2,I
Detail 4).
MANUAL
in Section 3.
PILOT'S ACTION
.DGAC
Approved:
I A I c I F IG I
3S0 82
SUP.16R
95-41
Page 5
"
.I
-i
FLIGHT
MANUAL.
3.4
Failure
of the ovro-cOll1Dass
INDICAiION
SYMPTa.1
-Failure
flag appears
on HSI (HDG).
3.5
Sudden failure
PILDT'SAmON
-Continue
flight.
SYMPTa.1
PILDT'SAmON
-Automatic
disengagement of faulty
channel
flight.
TRIM malfunction
INDICAiION
-TRIM light illuminates for 10 sec.
(Fig. 4) and defective trim disengages
autcxnatically.
SYMPTOM
PILDT'SAmON
DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I FIG
I
:
of the auto-oilot
INDICAiION
3.6
I'
350B2
SUP.16.
95-41
Page 6
.
.FLIGHT
MANUAL
3.7
BlockaQe of artificial
load svstem
INDICATION
SYMPTOM
-Blockage
of cyclic
PILOT'S
stic~
-Release
loads:
AmON
the stick
trim
flight.
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
~
.The blockage
persists:
break
c~ensator
shaft by applying
a 10 daN load approx
on cyclic stick.
3.8
.
.DGAC
SYMPTOM
PILOT'S
AmON
3.9
APproved:
I A I C I FIG
the autopilot
disengages
3S0 B2
SUP.16
95-41
Page 7
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
4 NORMAL
PROCEOURES.
Apart from the specific procedures given below, the normal procedures laid
down in the basic Flight Manual remain applicable:
~
4.1
-Cyclic
stick
-Friction
untightened
-Rudder
pedals
-Friction
tightened
-Static
;nverter
-Pushbutton
-Horizontal
Situation
-Pilot's
and copilot's
4.1.1
I-Released
Autopilot
Indicator
gyro horizons
in
test
-Test
pressed
selector
switch set to O.
.Pitch,
roll
engaged.
-Lights
on control panel (Fig.
1) illuminate.
-Lights
on AP monitoring
panel (Fig. 4) illuminate
(2 1/2 second time delay).
-Test function light (4)
(Figure 4) illum;nates.
-Test function light (4)
(Figure 4) extinguishes.
-P, R, Y , MONITpushbutton
lights illuminate (Fig. 1).
-Lights
below galvanometers
extinguish (Detail 4, F;g. 2).
-Check cyclic stick and
relevant galvanometer pointer
move in the right direction.
-Lights
below galvanometers
illuminate.
-AP light (Fig.5) blinks for
10 seconds.
-Lights
on control
.
panel
(Fig. 1) extinguish.
DGAC
Approved:
IA I C I FIG I
--
35082
SUP.16
95-41
Page 8
II
.FLIGHT
MANUAL
4.1.2
Failure
..,nitoring
-Pitch
channel engaged
unit test
-Pitch
pushbutton light
illuminates
(Fig.
1).
-GYRO warning
light
illuminates
(Fig. 4).
-MaNIT pushbutton light
flashes (Fig. 1).
-Pitch pushbutton light
extinguishes (Fig. 1).
-Test
-Roll
-Roll
pushbutton light
illuminates (Fig. 1).
-MONIT pushbutton light
illuminates (Fig. 1).
Pitch
trim test
-Pitch
channel engaged.
.
4.1.4
(Fig. 1)
channel engaged.
selector switch set to TRIll.
.DGAC
APproved:
I A 1 C I FIG
35082
SUP.16
95-41
Page 9
FLIGHT MANUAL
4.2
-Test selector
(Fig. 4).
channels
switch set to 0
4.3
4.3.1
4.3.1.1
in flioht
-Through
4.3.1.2
-Autopilot
holds attitudes.
-Autopilot
operates as a damper.
-Trim actuators are inhibited.
The actuators counteract
within the limits of their
authority.
-Deviation
in the direction of
operation of the attitude
references.
Yaw
-Feet
~
off
the pedals
: Collective
pitch/yaw
coupling is efficient
when some friction
is
applied to the pedals.
It is therefore
recomnendedto apply
friction.
DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I FIG I
350B2
SUP.16.
95-41
Page 10
.-
.
~
.FLIGHT
MANUAL
4.3.1.3
Coordinated turns
(T/C)
Additional
4.3.2.1
.
4.3.2.2
Altitude
(ALT)
Airspeed (A/S)
This mode may be operated when the airspeed is above 50 kt
(92 krn/h -57 mph).
Whenthis mode is engaged, the autopilot
airspeed through the pitch channel.
4.4
After
1andinQ
.5
stick pushbutton.
PERFORMANCE
Not affected.
.DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I FIG
35082
SUP.16
95-41
Page 11
.-
FLIGHTMANUAL
1F1~~~iF MIA~llJJlAl
/A$
~~[1))
1:m2
.$l1JJf~ll.rElMrE~'ir
EMERGENCY
FLOATATION
GEAR
per drawings:
350 A 82.8041.02
350 A 82.8042.00
IMPORTANT
NOTE
~~==_n//
O16.-ospar~
~=~IVISION
.DGAC
Approved:
[]
SOCIETENATIONALEINDUSTAIELLE
HELICOPTERES -DIRECTION
SUPPORTCLIENTS -B.P.176
350n2
-13723
-MAAIGNA/
FRANCE
Page1
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
PAGEINTENTIONALLY
LEFT BLANK
.
DGAC
Approved:
[I]
350
B2
SUP.17.P1 .
89-17 Page
2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.CUSTOMIZATION
AlC:
350 B2
-SIN:
LIST OF ADDITIONALAPPROVED
PAGES
SECTION
..
DATECODE
SECTION
PAGE
DAT~ CODE
THIS AIRCRAFTDOESNOTOFFERANYPARTICULARFEATURES
REQUIRINGTHE CUSTOMIZATION
OF THE FLIGHT MANUAL
ON
GREENPAGES.
LIST OF TI LATEST~
~~
REVISIaIIS
No
PAGE
Date
JIh
Date
~
REVISIOO, 0
~
APPROVED
DATE
89-17
...,""
DGACApproved:
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.17.P1
Page3
FlIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF CONDITIONAL
REVISIONS(RC)
This manual assigned
to the helicopter
mentioned on the
contains
the following
p1nk pages except those cancelled
conditions
are ccxnplied with.
title
page,
when the
CAUTION
IF A NORMAL
REVISION(RN) MODIFIESTHE PAGENUMBER
FOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNEDBELOW, THE READER WILL HAVE TO CHANGETHE NUMBEROF THE PINK
PAGE BY HAND, SO THAT THE INFORMATION REMAINS IN ACCORDANCE
WITH THE
PARAGRAPHCONCERNED.
.Section
Page
Date
is met:
.
NOTE: The date
-followed
.DGAC
Approved:
[J
---
of the last
week in this
two figures
year.
350 B2
of the
SUP
89-17
year
.17
.P3
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF RUSHREVISIONS(RR)
The Manual contains the following
No
..
SECTION -PAGE
additional
CODE
DATE
No
yellow pageCs) :
SECTION-PAGE
CODE
DATE
.
.DGAC
Approved:
[f]
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.17
.P4
Page 1
..~
flIGHT
MANU
.LIST
OF APPROVED
EFFECTIVE
PAGES
(1)
Evolut1on
page code
-R : Revised.
to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SECTION
PAGE
DATE
(1
I~~j
17. 0
P1 1
89-17
R',
-i
17.0
17. 0
17.0
17.0
17. 0
P1
P1
P3
P4
P5
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
N
N
N
N
N
2
3
1
1
1/1
801M
17. 0
89-17
17.0
89-17
17. 0
89-17
LISTa' n LATEST
~
~
REVISI~
SECTION
PAGE
DATE
(1
f'mw. REVISI~ : 0
~C ~
DATE
Date
Date
89-17
...,""~
.DGAC
Approved:
m
35082
Page 1
MO1M
FLIGHT MANUAL
.1~
The installation
is designed to allow the aircraft
or prepared hard ground with floats inflated.
The emergency floatation
.
.
to alight
on water.
to land on an airstrip
gear comprises:
I
2
LIMITATIONS
All limitations
specified in the basic Manual remain applicable,
independently of the following:
-Floats
stowed, system not armed
.no special limitations
-Floats
stowed, system armed or floatation
.maximum I.A.S.
in powered flight:
135 kt
(250
gear inflated
km/h)
maximumI.A.S.
float
inflation:
6600 ft
(2000
m)
.DGAC
Approved:
m
350 82
SUP
89-17
.17
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
3 EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
gear firing
-Fire
80
the float
kt
-148
inflation
cartridges
ditching,
check rotor
system
(RecoovnendedmaximlJn firing
speed
km/h)
20
IMPORTANT
rpm
NOTE:
of emergency floatation
in
autorotation
WHEN
speed
descent.
THE
HELICOPTER
IS
AFLOAT,
THE
FORWARD
DOORS
MUST
BE OPENED
BY ACTUATING
THE JETTISONCONTROL.
4 NORMAL
PROCEDURES
Normal procedures specified in the basic Manual remain applicable,
independently of the following:
-External
checks:
TEMPERATURE
C'
FAHRENHEIT
DEGREE
table:
-10
20
30
-50
68
86
40
104
50
122
PRESSURE
PSI
371
PRESSIONMINI BARS 2
HIN PRESSURE
PSI
3
OOTE: A placard
-pressure
.Float
-Arming
.Depress
[fJ
Approved:
the limit
gear
the FLOATARMING(ARM.FLOT.SEC)push-switch
DGAC
indicates
values.
illuninate
350
B2
SUP
89-17
.17
Page
.5
PERFORMANCE
~~~ergency
floatation
data specified
performance
gear
in stowage
position
which
is reduced
by 50 ft/mn
(15
the
except for
m/mn) at 55 kt
performance
climbing
lAS.
.
.
.DGAC
Approved:
350 82
SUP
89-17
--
.17
Page 3
~-
.a
FLIGHT MANUAL
~~
[F1L~~l}1]iF ~fi.\IMI1JJfi.\l
~~
~~ltlJ
1mt2
.:SrL!J(P>!F-'llE~[E~if.
per drawings,
350 A 82.8002
350 A 82-8003
IMPORTANT
NOTE
~~::==JJ/J
~~~I\lISION
.DGAC
Approved,
~
SUPPORTCL.IENTS -B.P.175
350 82
-13723
-HARIGNA/
FRANCE
SUP .18.P1
89-17
Page1
..
FUGHT MANUAl
[~~
The title
of the Supplement
Is replaced
by :
35OA B2-8002
35OA 82-8003
.
I
DGACApproved:
IAI
IclDIEIFIGIHI
350B2
SUP.18.P1
96-22
.RR.
.,
Page
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
PAGE
INTENTIONALLY
LEFT
BLANK
.
DGAC
Approved:
m
350
B2
SUP.18.P1 .
B9-17 Page
2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.CUSTOMIZATION
:
A/C,
350 B2
-SIN:
LIST OF ADDITIONALAPPROVED
PAGES
SECTION
..
PAGE
DATECODE
SECTION
PAGE
DATECODE
THIS AIRCRAFTDOESNOTOFFERANYPARTICULAR
FEATURES
REQUIRINGTHE CUSTOMIZATION
OF THE FLIGHT MANUAL
ON
GREEN
PAGES.
Na1MALREVISION: 0
DGACI'I'PROI,D
DATE
It)
Date
It)
Date
89-17
...,"""
.DGAC
Approved:
[IJ
350 82
SUP
89-17
.18.P1
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF CONDITIONAL REVISIONS (RC)
title
page,
when the
CAUTION
IF A NORMALREVISION (RN) MODIFIES THE PAGE NUMBERFOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNEDBELOW. THE READER WILL HAVE TO CHANGE THE NUMBEROF THE PINK
PAGE BY HAND, SO THAT THE INFORMATION REMAINS IN ACCORDANCEWITH THE
PARAGRAPHCONCERNED.
.Section
Page
Date
Applicable
before
condition
is met,
.
NOTE, The date
-followed
.DGAC
Approved:
[]
of the last
week in this
two figures
year.
350 B2
of
the
year
SUP .18.P3
89-17
Page1
.
.FLIGHT
MANUAL
RUSHREVISIONS(RR)
R,R No.
SUP.16
.SUP.16
IA
PAGE
CODE
DATE
P4.1
96-22
PI.1
96-22,
SUPPLEMENTS
RR No.
PAGE
CODE
DATE
.
.
DGACAppraved:
IAI
350 82
IclDIEIFIGIHI
5UP.18.P4
96-22
---~--
Page I
"RR"
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF RUSH REVISIONS (RR)
No
SECTION -PAGE
additional
CODE
No
yellow pageCs) :
SECTION-PAGE
CODE
DATE
DATE
..
.
.DGAC
Approved:
[]
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.18.P4
Page1
FLIGHT MANUAL
.LIST
OF APPROVED
EFFECTIVE
PAGES
(1)
SECTION
PAGE
18. 0
18.0
18. 0
18. 0
Pl
Pl
Pl
P3
18.
18.
18.
18.
18.
P4 1
P5 1/1
1
2
3
0
0
0
0
0
DATE (1
1
2
3
1
-01*
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
N
N
N
N
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
N
N
N
N
N
LIST OF THELATEST~
APPROVED
REVISIa-IS
~
Date
SECTION
PAGE
DATE (1
NOOMAL
REVISI~ : 0
DGAC1mIO\ID
Date
DATE
89-17
.:IN"
.DGAC
Approved:
[]
350 82
SUP
89-17
.18.P5
Page 1
-01*
FLIGHT MANUAL
.1~
hoists:
.
.DGAC
Approved:
~
350B2
SUP .18
89-17
Page1
-",,""
FLIGHT MANUAL
2 LIMITATIONS
HOIST OPERATIONS
MUSTBE IN ACCORDANCE
WITH OPERATING
REGULATIONS
GOVERNING
THESEOPERATIONS.
The limitations
laid dowf1in the basic Flight Manual r~ain
full with the addition of the following specific points:
-Minim~
crew:
one pilot
applicable
in
-Speed limitation
in forward flight
with hoist cable reeled in and no
load on :
.when aircraft
is fitted
with L.H. sliding door. is given in relevant
Suppl~ent.
.when L.H. door and sub-door are removed from aircraft
is
70 kt -81 MPH-130 kin/hr.
3
EMERGENCYPROCEDURES
4 NORMAL
PROCEDURES
The L.H. door and sub-door must be removed if the aircraft
with the sliding door.
Make sure that both cable guards are present and firmly
The jib locking bolt and the hoist operator's
support must be installed before take-off.
control
is not fitted
secured.
grip complete with
to the operator.
For carrying
out a hoisting
operation:
-Stabilize
the aircraft
in hover above the hoisting site
-Ensure sufficient
power reserve is available that will permit moving off
in forward flight once the load is hoisted on board.
-Set the jib in hoisting position.
DGAC
Approved:
~
350 B2
~lJfJ .Jlfl
89-17
Page2
FLIGHT MANUAL
The hoist operator can now control the winch. To bring the load
into the cabin, unlock the jib and pivot it inwards.
The snap-hook can be used to hold the load while the hoist
unhooked.
Do not moveoff
in forward flight
until
cable is being
With -Air Equipment- hoist, when rigid compact loads (over 80 kg -176 lb
post mod AMS1587) are being hoisted inconsequential oscillations
may
appear. Operate the hoist.
OOTE1 : AIR EQUIPEMENT
hoist
Overheating of the winch motor must be avoided. Consequently
never exceed 6 consecutive hoisting operations plus one
descent with maximlJn load, and maximLlncable reel-l!t
or equivalent.
OOTE2 : BREEZEhoist
After each operation of the winch (lowering
seconds. After three complete cycles (first
load, the following two lowerings with no
raisings at full
load) it is recommendedto
forty minutes.
5
or raising) wait 30
lowering with maximLln
load; plus three
stop the winch for
PERFORMANCE
With hoist
applicable.
jib folded.
.;;
.DGAC
Approved:
350 B2
[J
SUP
89-17
--
.18
Page 3
--l
FLIGHT MANUAL
.95
Ifl~~~'ir
/A$
MIM~lAl
~~!I))
1m2
.$llJJlFfl[EI);i][E~if.
FORWARD
TWO-PLACE
SEAT
As per drawings:
350A 82.2046.
350A 82.2047.
or
350A 82.2128.
350A 82.2129.
350A 82.2046.
IMPORTANT
NOTE
The information contained herein supplements or
supersedes the information given in the basic Flight
Manual and/or applicable Flight Manual supplements.
~~::==:...u//
~~IVISION
.DGAC
Approved:
m
OJ6.-ospa:'..a. SOCIETENATIONALEINDUSTRIELLE
HELICOPTERES-OIRECTION
SUPPORTCLIENTS -B.P.175
350B2
-1:372:3 -HARIGNA/
~lJfJ .~
89-17
FRANCE
.fJ1l
Page1
FLIGHT
MANUAL
.
PAGEINTENTIONALLY
LEFT BLANK
.
DGAC
Approved:
[J
350
B2
SUP.21.P1 .
89-17
Page2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.CUSTOMIZATION
:
A/C:
350 B2
-SIN:
LIST OF ADDITIONALAPPROVED
PAGES
SECTION
..
PAGE
DATE CODE
SECTION
PAGE
DATE CODE
Date
89-17
No
~
REVISI~ : 0
OOACAPPROVED
DATE
Date
...I~N
.DGAC
Appr-oved:
[IJ
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.21.P1
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF CONDITIONAL REVISIONS CRC)
title
page,
when the
CAUTION
IF A NORMAL
REVISIONCRN) MODIFIESTHE PAGENUMBER
FOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNEDBELOW, THE READER WILL HAVE TO CHANGETHE NUMBEROF THE PINK
PAGE BY HAND, SO THAT THE INFORMATION REMAINS IN ACCORDANCE
WITH THE
PARAGRAPHCONCERNED.
.Section
Page
Date
Applicable
before condition
is met :
.
NOTE: The date
-followed
.DGAC
Approved:
~
of the last
week in this
two figures
year.
350 B2
of
SUP
89-17
the
year
.21.P3
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF RUSHREVISIONS(RR)
The Manual contains
No
the following
SECTION -PAGE
addit1onal
CODE
DATE
No
yellow page(s) :
SECTION-PAGE
CODE
DATE
..
.
.DGAC
Approved:
[]
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.21.P4
Page 1
I
FLIGHT MANUAL
.LIST
OF APPROVED
EFFECTIVE
PAGES
(1)
Evolution
page code
-R : Revised.
to be replaced
-N : New. to be inserted
SECTION
21.
21.
0
0
PAGE
89-17
89-17
N
N
P1
3
P3 1
89-17
89-17
N
N
21.
21.
21.
21.
P4
P5
1
2
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
N
N
N
N
1
2
(1
21.
0
21.0
0
0
0
0
P1
P1
DATE
1
1/1
-01-
~
0
Oate
Date
SECTION
PAGE
DATE
(1
f'm.tI!L fEVISI~ : 0
~
ri'ffIOVED
DATE:
89-17
L'INGE
.DGAC
Approved:
~
350 82
SUP .21.P5
89-17
Page1
-01-
FLIGHT MANUAL
.1~
LIMITATIONS
with the
-The total weight of the two passengers on the forward two-place seat
shall not exceed 154 Kg (339 lb).
-The optional dual controls
forward two-place seat.
3
the
EMERGENCYPROCEDURES
All the emergency
applicable.
shall
procedures
specified
in the
basic
Flight
Manual remain
NORMAL
PROCEDURES
The normal procedures given in the basic Flight Manual remain applicable.
Special attention shall be paid to c.g. determination.
CAUTION: C.G. LIMITS AT EMPTYWEIGHTARE TO BE RE-DETERMINED
IN
-ACCORDANCE
WITH THE INFORMATION
CONTAINED
IN THE MAINTENANCE
MANUAL.WORKCARDNo. 25.22.20.401.
.DGAC
Approved:
m
350 B2
~LJf3 .~Jl
89-17
Page 1
~-
FLIGHT MANUAL
lJetermination
ofC.G.
limits
Forward two-place seat
350 A 82.2128
350A82.2047
350A 82.2129
Weight
10.1 kg -22.27
Moment
17.2mkg-1490 inlb
kg
m.kg
lb
in.lb
5
350 A 82.2046
50
85
60
102
70
119
1.70 m -66.93
80
136
lb.
11.4 kg -25.22
lb
19.4mkg-1688 inlb
in.
170
187
204
221
238
255
100 125 150 175 200 225 250 275 300 325
6693 8366 10039 11712
PERFORMANCE
The approved performance data given in the basic Flight
relevant Supplements remain applicable.
IJGAC
Approved,
~
35082
Manual and
.
SUP .21 .
89-17 Page2
-.eurocopter
FLIGHT
MANUAL
8
FLIG HT MAN UAL
AS
8
350
82
SUPPLEMENT
OP 1760
350 A 82.5067.00
IMPORTANT
NOTE
The informetion
contained
herein supplements
or supersedes
the information
given
in the basic flight manual and/or applicable
flight manual supplements.
The effectivity
of the supplement
at the latest revision is specified
on the list of
Effective Pages.
This
supplement
supports
the
helicopters
THIS SUPPLEMENT
supplement
are made
es AEROSPATIALE.
MUST BE INCLUDED
delivered
by both
by EUROCOPTER
j~EROSPATIALE
FRANCE
using
the
-:::;~:;:=::'.gd
~~--~
DGACApproved:
IAlclDIEIFIGIHI
EUROCOPTER
FRANCE
Etabllssement de Marlgnane
350 82
SUP.23.P1
89-17
Pagel
FLIGHT MANUAL
8
DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I DIE I FIG I HI
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.23.P1
Page2I
FLIGHT MANUAL
CUSTOMIZATION
:
~
LIST OF ADDITIONALAPPROVED
PAGES
SECTION
PAGE
DATECODE
SECTION
PAGE
DATECODE
8
LIST OF THE LATESTNORMAL
APPROVEDREVISIONS
No
0
Date
No
Date
NORMALREVISION: 0
DGACAPPROVED
DATE: 26 0
89-17
.
L'1_au.
DGAC
Approved:
I A I C I DIE I FIG I HI
350 82
SUP
89-17
.23.P1
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF CONDITIONAL REVISIONS (RC)
CAUTION
IF A NORMAL REVISION (RN) MODIFIES THE PAGE NUMBERFOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNEDBELOW, THE READER WILL HAVE TO CHANGETHE NUMBEROF THE PINK
PAGE BY HAND, SO THAT THE INFORMATION REMAINS IN ACCORDANCEWITH THE
PARAGRAPHCONCERNED.
Section
Page
Date
Applicable
before
condition
;s
met :
: The date
followed
DGACApproved:
I A I C I DIE
I F I C;I H I
two figures
year.
350 B2
of the
year
SUP.23.P3
89-17
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF RUSH REVISIONS (RR)
No
the
SECTION -PAGE
following
additional
CODE
DATE
No
yellow
page(s)
SECTION-PAGE
CODE
DATE
8
DGACApproved:
IA 1 C 10 1 E IF 1 G I H 1
350 82
SUP
89-17
.23.P4
Page 1
..
FLIGHT MANUAL
DOT CERTIFICATION
(1)
Page Revision
Code
-R : Revised,
to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
SUP.23
SUP.23
SUP.23
SUP.23
SUP.23
SUP.23
SUP.23
SUP.23
PI
PI
PI
P3
P4
P5
DATE
1
2
3
1
1
1/01
1
2
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
(1)
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
DATE
(1)
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
8
LIST OF THE LATEST NORMAL
APPROVED REVISIONS
No
Date
89-17
No
NORMAL REVISION:
DGAC APPROVED
Date
DATE:26 0
L'1N88N'.UR
.
DGAC Approved:
350 82
SUP
89-17
.23.P5
Page1
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
GENERAL
~
,..,
be kept at a
the use of anti-ice
additives.
The fuel is wanmed up by the engine oil circulating
through a heat
exchanger before
it returns
to the oil tank.
The fuel temperature
is
monitored
by a regulating
system. An indicator
light
illuminates
when
the operating
temperature
range is exceeded.
10
'
CIRCUIT
CARBURANT
FUELSYSTEM
.--HEAT
.;
~
0
~
OIL SYSTEM
10i1
tank
2 Thenma1 valve
3 Oil coolers
4 Thenma1 switches
5 Indicator
light
I
6 Fueltank
DGA( Approved:
I A I (I
DIE
I FIG
FUEL SYSTEM
7 Booster pumps
8 Oil/Fuel
heat exchanger
9 Thermal capsule
(fuel
temperature)
10 Heat exchanger by pass-valve
350 82
I HI
SUP.23I
89-17
Page 1
.,.
FLIGHT MANUAL
LIMITATIONS
The limitations
specified in Section 2 of the basic Flight
applicable
except for the limitations
mentioned below:
Manual remain
$
'fI1
is limited
3 EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
-Illumination
of the fuel temperature amber light (FUEL T') if temperature
is less than +5'C or greater than +50'C :
In flight
avoid sudden power variations
and monitor the filter
pre-clogging
indicator light in cold weather.
4
NORMAL
PROCEDURES
The normal procedures specified
applicable.
~
~
Manual remain
PERFORMANCEDATA
Manual remain
8
DGAC Approved:
I A I C I DI ElF
350 B2
I GI~J
SUP
89-17
.23I
Page 2
---I
FLIGHT MANUAL
.G
eurocopter
FLIGHT
MANUAL
AS 350
82
.SUPPLEMENT
PROTECTION
OF THE AIR INTAKE
AGAINST INDUCTION OF SNOW
Optional:
IMPORTANT
OP 2561
NOTE
..
This supplement
supports
the helicopters
delivered
by both AEROSPATIALE
by EUROCOPTER
FRANCE
using
THIS SUPPLEMENT
MUST BE INCLUDED IN THE FLIGHT MANUAL WHEN
EQUIPMENT
MENTIONED ABOVE IS INSTALLED ON THE AIRCRAFT.
-~::=::.w
~-=t([
.DGAC
EUROCOPTER
FRANCE
Etablissement
Approved:
I A I 8 I CI D I
the
THE
de Marignane
35082
SUP .25.P1
93-09
Page 1
,;,;,
,;~ ,,
.:;;"
FLIGHT MANUAL
(1)
Evolution
-R
-N
: Revised, to be replaced
: New, to be inserted
SUPPLEMENT
SUP.25
SUP.25
SUP.25
SUP.25
SUP.25
SUP.25
SUP.25
SUP.25
SUP.25
DOT CERTIFICATION
page code
P1
P5
PAGE
DATE
1
1/01
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
93-09
93-09
93-09
93-09
93-09
93-09
93-09
93-09
93-09
.DGAC
Date
93-09
Approved:
m
No
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
DATE
(1)
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
(1)
NORMAL REVISION:
DGAC APPROVED
Date
DATE:
26)UIL.
35082
0
1993
SUP.25.P5
93-09
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
.1~
This installation
is designed to protect the air
potential
induction of snow in flight,
in falling
intake against
snow.
any
LIMITATIONS
The limitations
laid down in the basic Flight Manual remain applicable,
with the exception of the flight
envelope restrictions
in case of falling
snow which are cancelled.
.
3
EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
The Emergency Procedures specified
applicable.
in the basic
Flight
Manual remain
NORMALPROCEDURES
The Normal Procedures specified
in the basic Flight Manual remain
applicable,
but are completed by the following
procedures:
EXTERNALCHECKS
-Engine
air
intake:
.remove
snow or ice from the air intake grid,
.open the engine cowling,
.check
for snow, ice or water in the air intake,
the snow protection
device.
and particularly
under
ENGINE CONDITIONCHECK
.Use
.DGAC
Approved:
I A I BI CI DI
of the following
page (Figure
1).
given in Section
350 B2
4,
SUP.25
93-09
Page 1
c-FLIGHT MANUAL
,.::
:'::'::~.-:::,::
'::' .
30
.~W
'
.;
':
10
x
...
III
.:
~
-10
-30
-20
(FTX100)
(MX100J
100
.0
.;
.,
III
..0
...
.;
50
f
,;
..
400
; 390'
,t,./.,,)
..~
.Z
.,
0
:>
380
CWPLE
Figure
1 :
Engine
DGAC
Approved:
IA I 8 I C I DI
TORQuE'
X )
Air
Intake
35082 SUP.25
.
93-09
Page 2
FLIGHT MANUAL
.5
PERFORMANCE
The Perfomance Data specified
in Section 5.1 of the basic Flight Manual are
unaffected.
with the exception of the following
specific
performance data:
FLIGHT CONFIGURATION
I.G.E.
HEATING AND
HEATINGAND/ORDEMISTING
DEMISTING SYSTEMS
SYSTEMSOPERATING
OFF
hover
Figure
O.G.E. hover
Figure
Figure
.Rate-of-climb
Figure 2 minus 60 kg
(130 lb)
Figure 3 minus 60 kg
(130 lb)
Figure 5
.
.DGAC
APproved:
I AI 8 I CI D I
35082
SUP .25
93-09
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
6000.,~
20000
~ 18000
++-++
~ 16000
H.fII-
~
~
~t
.~
5000 5
:)f-
C/)
C/)
f-
-J
a 14000
U!
Ck:
~
~
~
C/)
:..
:)
4000
,:)
(/) 12000
U!
~
...l-
!l-
II:
a:
aU!
c
f-
1'-J
10000
11.i
CI
3000
8000
2000
6000
4000
1000
0
0
2000
! -10~0 if Ii 11
1500
~010~ ..~510~
.,
~OOO '
2000
22)0 (kg)
MASSEWEIGHT
-:05.
2500
I
Figure 2
CONDITIONS
-Height:
-Heating
5 ft
-1.5
and demisting
Tr~
systems off
DGAC
Approved:
~::
..n.=n
n~nrnn
r~
IGE HOVERPERFORMANCE
I
350
82
SUP
.25.l
93-09
Page
4
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
20000
6000
~ 18000
~
~
~-
~ 16000
5000
.00
+...
I-
00
.l1J
-J
<I 14000
II:
.~.
l1J
n.
.l1J
II:
~
'4000
0
~
00
I-
00
UJ 12000
a:
n.
I-
-J
<I
"0
10000
3000
"
8000
2000
6000
4000
0
0 2000
.~
-10:000
Iii
1500
3010~
..3510~
2000
0
0 ~OIOO
~510~
MASSEWEIGHT
Figure
1000
-~05
2250
0 5b'oo
(kg)
2500
0 (lob;
~
3
CONDITIONS
-No
wind
-Heating
.DGAC
and demist;ng
Approved:
I A I 8 I CI D I
systems
off
"'"~ .."."'"
"~n~""
r~
OGE HOVER PERFORMANCE
350 82
SUP
93-09
I
I
.25
Page 5
FLIGHT MANUAL
31
33
~
f38
~o
10<
,I
j"l
f.cz
,I r1/
f.co
.-
..I~
"'i'
fo48
~.
,I
it;
I:;
~ ;)' l/
0
62
'I
"
e.
...'",
60
:; ,
' , 1001
1/
I
I;
,'..
rJl ,",'
'I
"
l/
..J
~
~
! i
/,
;..
J;
II
.;
' .!
,.
i ;
II
...'-..
.."
,'J ,
.: .
go!;
.;
~
s
.
i
:/
-co -30 -20 -10
! ;
10 20 30 40 50 60 1500
2000
2500
2500
HASSE
CORRIE' ~CTED ~[GlT
Figure 4
NOTE:
CORRECTED
WEIGHTTO
-DETERMINE
Weight limitation
with internal
load:
2250 kg (4961lb)
DGAC Approved:
I A I B I CI DI
RATES OF CLIMB
350 B2
SUP.25
93-09
.
Page 6
i;,.
! ~;"
FLIGHT
MANUAL
...,..,..,..
...f..!
.j-.j..
.T.tf..f..
" , ,,
.,
..."
, "
-..:..:
:
",','
'.'
..'
.:..
';
"
.,
:
,
,
t.t..f..l..
, ,
"',
.", .,.,
;:
.l..1.;..j...~-~..-1-.
i
,
;
,
::
"
: : ::
.,..j. .~..(..1.-l--
::::
",.
::
"
:
,."
::::
::
::::
.-I.}
..t.:
, .j-.j.
"
, -1.-1.
.,
.I
;:;:
.",
,','
,..'
".,
10 20 30
40 50 60
...j--j-.
.1.-1.-1.-1..
"
",'
-to.t.
-40-30-20-10
.1..t..:..1..
0
500
('C)
1~
VI~
Figure
1500
2(XX)
ASC. I RllJEa:a.I/6
2500
Ift/nn)
CONDITIONS
-Max.
-IAS
.DGAC
continuous
55
kt
-102
Approved:
I A I B I CI DI
power
rating
km/hr
n.~
n~ r'TUD
RATE
OF
350 B2
CLIMB
SUP.25
93-09
Page 7
-'8
eurocopter
FLI~MANU
FLIGHT
AS
MANUAL
350
82
.SUPPLEMENT
LONG AND SHORT FOOTSTEPS
LONG D.350-591-111-a
SHORTD.350-591-113
.IMPORTANT
NOTE
The information
contained
in the basic flight manual
herein supplements
and/or supplements
The effectivity
of the supplement
Effective Pages.
at the latest
or supersedes
the information
listed in supplement
O.
revision
is specified
on the
given
List of
:~:=:::.J!l
.~::r:--=-q
--:-
EUROCOPTER
Direction
Technique
Support
DGACApproved:
I AIc IDI FI HI
350 82
SUP.28.P1
99-21
Page 1
.FLIGHT
MANUAL
DOT CERTIFICATION
(1)
Page Revision
Code
-R : Revised, to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
.
.
.
SUP.28
SUP.28
SUP.28
P1
PS
1
1/01
1
DATE
99-21
99~21
99-21
SUPPLEMENT PAGE
DATE (1)
N
N
N
NORMAL REVISION 0
DGAC APPROVED
DATE: 14 JUIN 1999
~~lR;t!t
99-21
OGAC
APproved:
w
(1)
350 82
SUP
99-21
.28.P5
Page1
...
FLIGHT MANUAL
1
.
GENERAL
The long
footstep
cabin
access
and
(PIN D.350-591-111-a)
on the
inspection
of the transmission
high landing
platform.
gear
faci1ates
EMERGENCYPROCEDURES
The
emergency
Supplements
procedures
remain
specified
in
the
basic
Flight
and
relevant
NORMALPROCEDURES
Manual
applicable.
PERFORMANCE
Performance data given in the basic Flight Manual and relevant Supplements
remain applicable but are completed by the following procedures:
-Rate
of climb:
reduce
by 2,5 %.
.
.N
DGACApproved:
I A I C I D I FI HI
35082
SUP.28!
99-21
L~
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
~~~
~t1Q\r;
aeroSPa!ja!e
~g~e
~,
I?IbO@
OO'V
~/!~ ~ /j\11
!A~ ~~@ @~
.~1P~@OlAlb
~!1JJIPIPl6~~~~V
per drawings:
3S0A 82.2005
3S0A 8202036
IMPORTANTNOTE
-~::;:=::'...n;7
~~
.DGAC
SOCIETE
NATIONALE
INDUSTRIELLE
-
Approved:
CD
-aerospatide
350 82
SUP
89-17
.50.P1
Page1
FLIGHT MANUAL
8
PAGE INTENTIONALLY
BLANK
DGAC
Approved:
350 B2
SUP.so.P18
89-17
LEFT
--
Page 2
FLIGHT MANUAL
CUSTOMIZATION
:
A/C:
350 B2
-SIN:
PAGE
DATE CODE
SECTION
PAGE
DATECODE
..
REQUIRINGTHE CUSTOMIZATION
OF THE FLIGHT MANUALON
GREEN
PAGES.
Date
89-17
No
NORMAL REVISION: 0
DGACAPPROVED
Date
DATE: 260
L'.DGAC
Approved:
350 B2
SUP
89-17
.50.P1
Page 3
FLIGHT MANUAL
OF CONDITIONAL
COMPosmON
REVISIONS (RC)
~
IF A NORMALREVISION (RN) MODIFIES THE PAGENUMBER
FOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNED
BELOW,THE READERWILL HAVETO CHANGE
THE NUMBER
OF THE PINK
PAGEBY HAND, SO THAT THE INFORMATIONREMAINSIN ACCORDANCE
WITH THE
PARAGRAPH
CONCERNED.
.Section
Page Date
.
NOTE: The date is coded and consists of the last two figures
-followed
by the number of the week in this year.
.DGAC
Approved:
W
35082
of the year
SUP.50.P3
89-17
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
OF RUSH
COMPOSITION
REVISIONS (RR)
No
the following
SECTION -PAGE
additional
CODE
No
yellow
page(s) :
SECTION-PAGE
CODE
DATE
DATE
.'.
.
.DGAC
Approved:
W
35082
SUP.50.P4
89-17
Page 1
FLIGHT MANUAL
.LIST
OF APPROVED
EFFEmVE PAGES
(1) Evolution page code
-R : Revised, to be replaced
-N : New, to be inserted
SEmON
PAGE
50. 0
50. 0
50.0
50. 0
50.0
50.0
50. 0
50. 0
50. 0
Pi
Pi
Pi
P3
P4
P5
DATE
1
2
3
1
1
1/1*01*
1
2
3
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
Date
89-17
No
(1)
SEmON
PAGE
(1)
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
NORMAL REVISION:
DGAC APPROVED
Date
DATE
DATE:
26
iflfOGENl.DGAC
Approved:
W
350 82
SUP.SO.PS
89-17
Page 1
*01*
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
GENERAL
~ge
of the helicopter
can be increased by installing
a special ferry
flight
tank transversally
in the rear cabin area.
The installation
consists essentially
of :
-A 475-litre
(125-US gal.) capacity removable tank. The unusable fuel
quantity
is negligible.
-A vent line
-A fuel transfer
line, with an isolating
valve. between the ferry fuel
tank and main fuel tank.
LIMITATIONS
niIS INSTALLATIONIS TO BE USEDONLYFOR FERRYFLIGHT WITH THE SPECIAL
PERMISSIONOF THE COMPETENT
AUTHORITIES.
The limitations
In addition:
laid
-Only
personnel
authorized
to
indispensable
to
fly
in the aircraft.
the
accomplishment
-Smoking is prohibited.
due to the presence of fuel
cabin.
-Maximum airing of the cabin is to be ensured.
of
the
mission
are
The weight of fuel that can be carried in the ferry tank will depend on the
loading of the helicoPter
and can be determined by referring
to the C.G.
chart. bearing in mind that the forward c.g. limit on take-off with a full
main tank must not be exceeded.
.
.DGAC
Approved:
W
350 B2
SUP.50
89-17
Page1
FLIGHT MANUAL
3 EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
.
NORMALPROCEDUBES
Checks before
fillina
the tank
attached.
installed.
Drocedure
-Fill
the main fuel tank
-Fill
the ferry tank to the amount previously determined..
-Check C.G. location:
.Weight and moment of empty ferry tank are given in Section 6
.Fuel is located at 91.3 in. (2.32 m) from datum line.
In-fliaht
Drocedure
Gauge
Reading
90
80
70
60
50
Litres
805
705
605
505
405
4030
305
20
205
105
DGAC
APproved:
35082
-=
of fuel
l
Page
2
SUP.50.
FLIGHT MANUAL
...
When the
effective
transfer
valve is open itis
by making sure that
the fuel
important
to ensure that
gauge indicator
pointer
transfer
is
is moving
PERFORMANCE
The approved performance data contained in Section 4 of the Flight
are not affected by the ferry flight
tank installation.
Manual
...
...
...DGAC
Approved:
w
350 B2
SUP
B9-17
.50
Page 3
=-~~:-
FLIGHT
MANUAI
~~I_'eurocopter
.I
FLIG HT MAN UAL
AS
350
.SPECIAL
82
SUPPLEMENT
ABSEILING INSTALLATION
Per drawing:
IMPORTANT
The information
contained
in the basic flight manual
THIS
SUPPLEMENT
EQUIPMENT
-:~;::::;::
<::~r::.-
JJI!
~
DGACApproved:
!nI]
I
MUST
MENTIONED
NOTE
herein supplements
and/or applicable
The effectivity
of the supplement
Effective Pages.
355P84.0080
at the latest
BE INCLUDED
ABOVE
EU
Aeroport
AO
or supersedes
the information
flight manual supplements.
revision
IN THE
IS INSTALLED
CO
international
PTE
FLIGHT
on the
MANUAL
List of
WHEN
THE
ON THE AIRCRAFT.
Direction
Marseille-Provence
is specified
given
Technique
13725
350 B2
Marignane
Support
Cedex
SUP
99-37
-France
.56.P1
Page 1
.
FLIGHT
LIST
PAGES
DOT CERTIFICATION--(1)
Page Revision
-R
: Revised,
-N
: New, to
SUPPLEMENT
.
.
.
OF APPROVED EFFECTIVE
MANUAL
SUP.56
SUP.56
SUP.56
P1
P5
PAGE
DATE
1
1/01
1
99-37
99-37
99-37
ate
(1)
SUPPLEMENT
PAGE
DATE
(1)
N
N
N
ae
NORMALREVISION: 0
DGACAPPROVED
DATE: 13 SEP.1999
""
,;;:;CE~..
ur
-",..;
99-37
DGAC
Approved:
[IJ
Code
to be replaced
be inserted
35082
SUP.56.P5
99-37
Page 1
.
.
.
FLIGHT MANUAL
GENERAL
This installation
allows trained
personnel to perform abseiling.
It consists
of two rings fixed to the cabin floor
in front
of the
passenger'S
for the lower rail
of each
sliding
door. seats and of a protection
'
LIMITATIONS
THE USE OF THIS TYPE OF INSTALLATION IS SUBJECTEDTO THE APPROVALOF
THE COMPETENTOPERATIONALAUTHORITIES.
The limitations
specified
in the basic Flight
Manual and relevant
Supplements
remain applicable;
however, they are completed or
modified
by the following
limitations:
-Abseiling
is limited
to hover flight.
After
completion
of the abseiling
operation,
transition
or landing
is prohibited
with the ropes unwound.
-The
load on the abseiling
A plate affixed
close to
forward
flight
installation
is limited
to 120 kg per ring.
each ring indicates
the maximum load.
EMERGENCYPROCEDURES
The Emergency Procedures
specified
Supplements remain applicable.
to
in the basic
Flight
NORMALPROCEDURES
The normal Procedures
specified
in the basic Flight
Manual and relevant
Supplements
remain applicable;
however, they are completed by the
following:
-Before
takeoff,
determine
the weight and CG conditions
which will
prevail
during
the mission,
knowing that the load on the asbeil
ropes is located
at :
.2.24
m from the longitudinal
datum,
.1.09
m from the aircraft
centerline.
REGULATORYPERFORMANCE
DATA
The Regulatory
Performance
Data
specified
relevant
Supplements
remain
applicable.
in
the
basic
Flight
Manual
and
DGACApproved:
CAn]
350 B2
SUP
99-37
.56
Page 1I
..
, ,,~, ;-;#
~
FMS
D350-6
Page 1 of 4
~
Spacepoa
SIDE CARGO COMPARTMENT EXTENDERS
This supplement must be attached to the approved flight manual when the listed equipment is
installed. The information contained herein supplements the information in the basic Helicopter
Flight Manual. For limitations. procedures and performance data not contained in this document,
.consult
the Helicopter Flight Manual.
.~
CAA APPROVED
Amendment A
Date: 95.09.25
COQYn9I" 1995 by CART AERaSP~CE
LTUI
r ~ ,;, ...FMS
D3S0Page 2 of 4
.LOG
OF AMENDMENTS
Rev.
No.
A
Pages
Revised
NEW
ISSUE
Revised By
and Date
B. Williams
95.09.25
d By
e
Inserted By
0;;2
.
.
CAA APPROVED
Date
Inserted
--~
::r~ , ;# -FMS
D350-60Q
Page 3 of 4
.SECTION
1 -GENERAL
NO CHANGE
SECTION
2 .LIMITATIONS
.INTERNAL
Maximum
GARGO LOADING
Load in the LH (Port) Hold:
3641b
(165 kg)
Maximum
CAA PPROVED
Amendment:
95.09.25
r~';,~
FMS D350-600U
Page 4 of
.SECTION
3 .EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
NO CHANGE
SECTION
4 -NORMAL
PROCEDURES
SECTION
5 -REGULATORY
PERFORMANCE
DATA
CLIMB
Climb perfon-nance will be reduced by up to 100 fpm when pods installed.
",,';I
't;JJ
9;]
CAA APPROVED
Amendment
95.09.25
FMS 0350-607
Page 1 of 4
INC
PO Box 23003
Victoria International Airport
Sidney, BC, Val 5N7, Canada
Tel: 6046562262
Fax: 604 656 2993
FLIGHT
MANUAL
EUROCOPTER
SUPPLEMENT
AS 350 MODELS
This supplement must be attached to the approved flight manual when the listed equipment is
installed. The information contained herein supplements the information in the basic Helicopter
Flight Manual. For limitations, procedures and performance data not contained in this document,
consult the Helicopter Flight Manual.
COMPLIANCE
DOT APPROVED:
L.B. Samail
Regional Airworthiness
Pacific Region
LIMITATIONS
IS MANDATORY.
Engineer
Amendment:A ~
Date: May20th, 1994 Y\
Copynghl
INC
L.B.
FMS 0350-607
Page 2 of 4
LOG OF AMENDMENTS
Rev.
No.
A
Pages
Revised
None
Revised By
and Date
J.Bradley
May 16, 199
DOT APPROVED
Approved
By
and Date
Samail
May 20th, 1994
Inserted
By
Date
Inserted
1
SECTION
NORMAL
FMS 0350-607
Page 3 of 4
- LIMITATIONS
Vne
MAXIMUM
Vne
-124
KIAS
Autorotation Vne
MAXIMUM
AUTORATION
Vne
-100
KIAS
COMPATABILITY
He/i-Uti/ity-
PLACARD:
(located on lid)
2 -
135
-48
+48
65
in
in
in
Ib
/
/
/
/
+3422 mm
-1222 mm
+1222 mm
29.5 kg
PROCEDURES
PREFLIGHT
Ensure lid is closed and securely latched.
DAILY INSPECTION
Check physical integrity and security of the Heli-Utility-Basket'"
DOT APPROVED
Amendment:
A%
May 20, 1994
FMS 0350-607
Page 4 of 4
SECTION
3 -EMERGENCY
PROCEDURES
NO CHANGE
SECTION
4 -
DATA
CRUISE
Vh reduced by up to 15 KIAS
CLIMB
Rate of climb may be reduced by up to 200 FPM
AUTO RATION
Rate of descent may be increased by up to 100 FPM
HOVER
No Change
DOT APPROVED
PERFORMANCE
Amendment:A of
May 20, 1994
..~.
'Ilnittd
,S'tatt5 of Imrrica
Bcperrmcnrof~raMporrerion-:.fcdcrul lnierionldmini.5rrarion
~upplementel~!!pe ():ertificete
3k~~~
I'~.d.a.tde.
-c
""~
J~'2k
Dart Aero AccessoriesInc.
P.O. Box 23003 CDO
Vicwria InternationalAirport
Sidney,British Columbia
Canada V8L SN7
~ -de-r
~'"
ro'te- j:.II.,..,.;,,?,/"~
SR00213NY
d-de-'/';",,a.(.;..-n.J,,d~k."",,
~.a4-l'uufA..,...Q7I/~./4--de-.a.v-.,y,.d';'~/H~,;,..."...",tJ-
,;:,!/f",..: 27
~1h..Federal Aviation
.~~..""'.
11 ./t.iZl .~,." /, -, ~
"t.~--(~"'~w",'-"
--::' ,...I! .A/
1:""':;,,""""
..,/Ide-
EurocopterFrance
.-II:..kl:
AS-3S0B,AS-3S0B1,AS3S0B2,AS3S0BA,AS-3S0C,AS-3S0D,
AS-3S0Dl, AS3SSE,AS3SSF,AS3SSFI. AS3SSF2
("If.
,./"/(:I' ./"
/
.:r:~""'i'/""'7'
~:Yiu./ ~,y". ~":/"':
~. ..llationof Utility Basketin accordancewith Dart Aero Accessories,Inc., DrawingNo. D3S0-607,Rev. B, datedFebruary22
1994,
~ d...k.:J,/?".
'" ,u:f.-:"",af
.lu4j ,uk..t;',.,.,..,k,( ,... 4' t".,.",;,,-n~;'.,. ~Ie, .4,,-/h
.~~"",.
("'}'".,./"", ,('/4"":,,,;,/..,./
I'
/
Y"I,
,I ':1':1'"""/,;,,
':-I~,k'I ,;,""'~"u
,#,.,
;;.e-...1.!'a/~.ty.d..,.f/t/-",:",;,
c:,',
J'U~-"""'"
/ .
9'nu""...d""/:
.O-I);:Ydf';~?;:~::~::b'"
Irwin N. Brumer(Slgnatu,.)
Mgr. New York Aircraft
CertificationOffice-
'.
I""/"",, -I de
!:1~
,$(QttSof gJmia
~upplrntrntel "'QC~pt:
~crtifi(ett:
(~ontinuationcShf:f:t)
JI/~-m~
SROO213NY
3. Dart Aero Accessories, Inc. Flight Manual Supplement FMS D355-607, Amendment A, dated May 20, 1994 (AS-355 Series
Only) is required with this STC.
4
approval should not be incorporated in any aircraft of these specific models on which other approved modifications are
in.. ..."rated, unless it is determined that the interrelationship between this change and any of those previously incorporated
approved modifications will not introduce any adverse effect upon the airworthiness of the aircraft.
-END-
Any altiration of thi! clTtificati i! puni!habli by afine of not ixciiding 11,000, or impri!onmint not ixciiding~ 3 ,liar!, . or both.
FAA FORM 8"OoZ.\ (100&0)
PAGE2 OF 2PAGES
.~p
Itmt;i";iNT
W~RTApprnuQ
Numbr: SH94-14
This
approval
is issued
to:
Issue
Canada
vaL
Responsible
Region
Aircraft/Engine
Type
Canadian
Approval
Description
Type
Date:
May 20,
1994
Date:
May 20,
1994
Pacific
or Model:
Eurocopter
or Equivalent:
Design
~.stal.lation/O~erating
, iulred
Equipment
Data,
Limitations:
Issue
5N7
of Type
a,':
Approval
No.:
H-83
Change:
Draw'.:ng
(AS-350
Utility
The Utility
accordance
France
Series)
Basket
Basket
Installation
with
ror
sealed
No.
0350-607,
AS-350B/Bl/B2/BA/C/D/D1
AS-355E/F/F1/F2
& H-87
(AS-355
Series)
Installation
Dart
Revision
is
to be carried
Aero Accessories
B,
dated
February
out L'l
Inc.
22,
1994*.
R~red
1)
Dart
Suppl~'lt
1994.
E~~,"-,
Aero
Accessories
Inc .Maincenance
Manual
MMS-0350-607,
Revision
A, dated
February
22,
2)
AS-350
Series
~y:
ror Approved
copy of Dart Aero
Accessories
L'lc.
Flight
~~
Suppl~'lt
FMS 0350-607,
Revision
A, dated
May 20, 1994*.
3)
AS-3SS Series
~y:
ror Approved
copy of Dart Aero
Accessories
L'lc.
Flight
Manual Suppl~~t
FMS 0355-607,
Revision
A, dated
May 20, 1994*.
(*
or
later
approved
revisions)
Conditions:
This approval is only applicable to the type I model
of aeronautical product specified therein. Prior to incorporating this
modification,
it shall be established
that the interrelationship
between this change and any other modification(s) incorporated
will not adversely affect the airwo
On
e m difie
roduct.
Regi
For Minister
2e035'
"oe.,
"-
eer
of Transport
Cana d...
a
06/19/.1.~:
/3
9058713599;
52AM;Je1ERA-#,178;a:.'
eurocoptercanada FLIGHT
AS 350/
AS 355 HELICOPTERS
Regional Airworthiness
Ontario Region
FMS-ECL-9
Engineer
3ent
by:
euro~ppter
9058713599;
eu rocopter
canada
GENERAL
06/19/a1O:52AM;JetFux
#178;.e
2/3
(unapproved)
".
CHEEKS)" are an enlargement of the LH and I or
The volume of the normal baggage compartment with no cargo pods installed is 7.1 cubic
fee1 on the right side with the battery in the basic helicopter configuration, and 8.3 cubic
fee1 on the left side.
With installation of the Cargo Pods ('SQUIRREL CHEEKS") on each side, the baggage
compartmen1 volume is almost doubled (right side 14.1 cubic feet, left side 15.3 cubic feet).
With the Cargo Pods C'SQUIRREl CHEEKS") installed, the RH cargo compartment can
carry up to 175 kg (386 Ib), and the LH compartment can carry up to 195 kg (430 Ib). They
are constructed with ~ reinforced a.luminium floor with no lip at the door for easier loa.ding.
The Cargo pod floor and top can be stood upon by maintenance personnel.
The Cargo Pods have large doors that are hinged to open in the forward direction, with gas
struts 10 hold the door in the open position.
The doors i~corp9rate high quality door latches which are easy to operate.
Additional RH Cargo Pod volume and weight capacity can be achieved with the additional
installation of Optional Equipment ECL-6, Battery Re/oca1ion.
FMS-ECL-9
08/19/00
tent
by
10:53AMj]etF8X
#178;Page
313
eurocopter
eu roc8:,ter
FLIGHT
MANUAL
AS350
canada
C, D, D1, B, 81,
AS355
82,83,
8A.
E, F, F1, F2
LIMITATIONS
No change
3.
EMERGENCY
AND MALFUNCTION
PROCEDURES
No change
4,
NORMAL PROCEDURES
No change
5,
PERFORMANCEDATA
The following performance data is equally applicable wi1h LH, RH or both Cargo Pods
ins1alled:
AS 350 C, D, 01,8,61,82,83,
a.
For hover IGE and OGE, use 1he standard performance charts in Section 5 of 'the
Flight Manual but reduce the resulting helicopter weight by 30 kg.
NOTE:
b.
BA
For Climb, use the standard performance chart in Section 5 of the Flight Manual, but
reduce the resul1ing rate of climb by the following amount:
0
B, 8A:
200 ft/min.
250 ft/min
AS 355 E, F. F1. F2
a.
Fot hover IGE and aGE, use the standard performance charts in Section 5 of the
Flight Manual but reduce the resulting helicopter weight by 60 kg.
NOTE:
b.
For Climb, use the standard perform:i\nce ch:i\rt in Section 5 of the Flight Manual, but
reduce the resulting rate of climb by the following amount:
0
for AS 355
AEOE, F, F1 and F2:
DEI
NOTE:
150ft/min
110ttlmin
DOT Approved:
Page
FMS-ECL-9
Rev. 2
--..
.
~
.-eurocopter
COMPlfMENTARY'.FLIC
MANUA
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT
.AS
MANUAL
350
REGISTRATION
82
No
SERIAL No
~~a
"""."",,,
'c'
,
IMPOR!~NTN~T~
The practical value of this manual depends entirely upon its being up-dated correctly
by the operator.
The effectivity of the manual at the latest revision is specified on the List of Effective
Pages.
-~:;:=::.
~::r~~
rJd
EU
RO
CO
PTE
Direction
Technique
Support
350 82
O.O.P1
99-38
Page 1
'COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
..
CUSTOMIZATION
~
IF A NORMALREVISION (RN) MODIFIES THE PAGENUMBERFOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNED
BELOW, THE READERWILL HAVE TO CHANGETHE NUMBEROF THE PINK
PAGE BY HAND, SO THAT THE INFORMATIONREMAINS IN ACCORDANCE
WITH THE
PARAGRAPH
CONCERNED.
SECTION
.THIS
PAGE
DATE CODE
SECTION
PAGE
DATE CODE
.
.R
350 B2
O.O.P1
l ~
99-38
page
3
" ~ II
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
.PART
WEIGHT
AND
..
BALANCE
SYSTEMSAND
DESCRIPTION
..
SERVICING
..
OPERATIONAL
INFORMATION
..
~DDITIONAL
.PERFORM~NCE"
350B2
O.O.P2
89-17
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF CONDITIONAL REVISIONS (RC)
title
page,
when the
CAUTION
IF A NORMALREVISION (RN) MODIFIES THE PAGE NUMBERFOR ANY INFORMATION
CONCERNED
BELOW, THE READERWILL HAVE TO CHANGETHE NUMBEROF THE PINK
PAGE BY HAND, SO THAT THE INFORMATION REMAINS IN ACCORDANCE
WITH THE
PARAGRAPH
CONCERNED.
N'
RCA
SECTION -PAGE
7.7
DATE
99-38
MOD.072453
99-38
RC B
7..8
99-38
MOD. 072272
RC C
7.11
99-38
MOD. 071827
RCD
7.11
99-38
MOD.072488
RC E
8.4
99-38
RC F
8.4
99-38
MOD. TU 232
RC G
8.4
4
8
99-38
99-38
"
.
~
MOD. 072720
.
\J
.
8
by the
number of the
of the year
year.
350 B2
O.O.P3
99-38
Page 1
..COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
COMPOSITION
OF RUSH REVISIONS (RR)
.0.0.P4
N RR
SECTION
PAGE
DATE
CODE
7A
8.4
4 "RR"
8 "RR"
02-14
02-14
78
9.2
9.2
7 "RR"
8 "RR"
02-20
02-20
1 "RR"
02-20
N RR
SECTION
PAGE
DATE
CODE
.
.350B2
O.O.P4
02-20
Page 1
"AR"
.
COMPLEMENTARY FLIGHT MANUAL
.COMPOSITION
OF
RUSH REVISIONS (RR)
The manual contains the following additional yellow page(s) :
.6C
No.RR
SECTION
PAGE
DATE
CODE
SA
8.4
7 RR'
00-12
66
8.4
11 'RR'
00-14
0.0.P4
1 'RR'
00-41
8.4
7 RR'
00-41
No.RR
SECTION
PAGE
DATE
CODE
i.
.35062
O.O.P4
00-41
Page 1
'RR'
..COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
LIST OF EFFECTIVEPAGES
(1) PageRevisionCode
-R : Revised, to be replaced
-N
: New, to
SECTION
PAGE
0.0
0.0
O. 0
O.
0
O. 0
Pi
P1
P2
P3
P4
O. 0
6. 0
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
6. 1
7.0
7. 0
7. 0
7. 0
7. 0
7. 1
P5
P6
7. 2
7.
be inserted
P6
1
3
1
1
1
1/03
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
1
1
2
3
4
1
DATE (1)
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
89-17
99-48
99-38
89-17
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
92-12
92-12
99-38
SECTION
7.
i 7.
i 7.
I' 7.
7.
PAGE
DATE (1)
3
3
3
4
4
2
3
4
1
2
89-17
89-17
99-38
89-17
99-38
7. 5
7. 5
7. 5
7. 5
7. 5
7. 6
7. 6
7. 7
7. 7
7. 7
7. 8
7. 8
7. 8
7. 8
7. 9
7.10
7.10
I 7.11
; 7.11
! 7.11
8. 0
8. 1
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
1
2
3
1
2
3
4
1
1
2
1
2
3
1
1
89-17
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
89-17
92-12
99-38
89-17
89-17
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
P6
8. 1
8. 2
35082
89-17
0.0. P5
,,: ..
..99-48
Page 1
"'1"1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
SECTION
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
8.
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
38M
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
PAGE
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
1
2
3
4
5
DATE (1)
99-38
99-38
99-38
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
SECTION
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
8. 4
9. 0
9. 1
9. 1
9. 1
9. 2
9. 2
9. 3
9. 4
9. 4
9. 4
9. 5
9. 6
9. 7
9. 7
9. 8
9. 8
9. 8
9. 9
9.10
9.10
9.11
9.11
9.11
9.11
P6
PAGE
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
1
1
2
3
1
2
1
1
2
3
1
1
1
2
1
2
3
l'
1
2
1
2
3
4
DATE (1)
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-48 R
89-17
89-17
89-17
99-48 R
99-48 R
89-17
99-38
89-17
89-17
89-17
99-38
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
89-17
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
350 82
O.O.PS
99-48
Page 2
4It
..COMPLEMENTARY
SECTION
PAGE
~.11
9.12
9.27
9.27
9.27
9.27
9.27
9.27
9.27
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
10.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
DATE (1)
5
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
P6
99-38
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
92-12
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
99-38
Date
No
Date
89-17
99-48
92-12
93-05
PAGE
DATE (1)
NORMAL
No
SECTION
MANUAL
92-12
93-05
99-48 N
99-48 N
99-48 N
99-48 N
99-48 N
99-48 N
99-48 N
.4
FLIGHT
REVISION:
93-15
99-38
350 82
O.O.P5
99-48
Page 3
--
.;
.'
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
,
SECTION6
Pages
6.1
...5
2 WEIGHT
ANDBALANCE
3 WEIGHING
4 LONGITUDINAL CG LOCATION
LATERAL
CGLOCATION
10
13
...
...N
350B2
6.0.P6
99-38
"'--
,;;"
Page 1
~ ~~ ~,
:;:==;=;;=
.
.
'c
4.1.2
4.1.2.1
LOMPlEMENTARYFUGHT
MANUAL
mission
Before takeoff
EEW
Crew
Passengers
C.g.
i.e.
4.1.2.2
In flight
1200
160
140
4272
248
356
400
1390
1950
6426
50
--
TOTAL
:
longitudinal
m.kg
160
.11: = 3.295 m
1950
c.g. is within
or on landing
EEW
Crew
Passengers
Side cargo hold
Fuel
kg
m.kg
1200
160
140
50
50
4272
248
356
160
173
-TOTAL
longitudinal
i.e.
16DO
c.g.
c.g.
52D9
becomes: ~
= 3.255 m
1600
.R
350 B2
6. 1
99-38
Page 3
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
Crewand Passengers
0
0
.;
~
.;
.,
0
>"
METRIC UNITS
WEIGHT
MOMENT: m.kg
kg
LA)
(8)
60
80
100
120
140
160
180
200
220
240
260
280
30D
320
93
124
155
186
219
248
279
310
341
152
203
254
305
356
406
457
508
559
610
660
711
762
812
IMPERIAL
UNITS
WEIGHT
lb
100
150
200
250
300
.350
400
450
500
550
600
650
MOMENT: in. lb
(A)
(8)
6102
9153
12204
15255
18306
21357
24400
27459
30510
9999
12999
19998
24997
29997
34996
39996
44995
49995
54994
59994
64993
700
69993
35082
6.1
99-38
.
.
R
Page4
,.
4.2.2
COMPLEMENTARY
f'L1GHTMANUAL
.I
.1
~
c:
0;
0
0
:r;
,:
~
METRICUNITS
WEIGHT
ko
10
20
50
.70
80
100
120
150
200
250
300
310
MOMENT:m.kg
(C)
(A)
(8)
15.5
31.0
77.5
108.5
124.0
155.0
186.0
232.5
22.5
45.0
112.5
157.5
180.0
225.0
270.0
337.5
450.0
562.5
675.0
697.5
27.6
55.2
138.1
193.4
221.0
276.3
331.5
414.4
552.6
690.7
828.9
856.5
(D)
(E)
32
64
160
224
256
320
384
46
92
230
322
368
IMPERIALUNITS
WEIGHT
.1:0
'..
100
150
176
200
220
250
264
300
330
400
500
600
.682
MOMENT: in.1b
:::1
6102
9153
10740
12204
13424
15255
16109
18306
20137
4:::
8858
13287
15590
17716
19488
22145
23385
26574
29231
35432
44290
53148
60412
:::9
10878
16317
19036
21756
23931
27195
28718
32634
35897
43512
r!
:::9
12598
18897
22172
25196
27716
31495
33259
:~~5
18110
27165
31874
54390
65268
74188
35082
6. 1
99-38
---
Page 5
~-
;:
.COMPLEMENTARY
4.2.3
FLIGHT MANUAL
Fuel
~fEEj
~-,
--~-ffHJ
~
~
.I
I
1-
./
0.79
METRIC UNITS
litre
10
20
40
60
80
100
150
200
250
300
350
400
540
Ka
8
16
32
47
63
79
119
158
198
237
277
316
427
m.ka
28
56
111
163
219
275
414
549
688
824
963
1098
1484
.
IMPERIAL UNITS
UKgal.
5
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
110
119
lb
40
79
158
238
317
396
475
554
633
712
792
871
940
in.
Ib
5472
10808
21616
32561
43369
54177
64985
75793
86601
97409
108353
119161
128601
IMPERIAL UNITS
USgal.
lb
in. lb
USaal.
lb
in.lb
5
10
15
20
30
40
50
33
66
99
132
198
264
330
4515
9029
13544
18059
27088
36118
45147
70
80
90
100
110
120
130
462
527
593
659
725
791
857
63206
72099
81128
90158
99187
108217
117246
60
396
54177
143
940
128601
35082
6. 1
99-38
;~':",
Page6
4.3
.
CG Charts
The
know
the
following
the
charts
aircraft
limits,
it
(metric
should
be
These charts
are designed
CG move along
a vertical
Example
Examole
1 :
2 :
The weight
be modified
fitted.
units
and
centre-of-gravity.
Imperial
When
confirmed
so that
line.
the
by
calculations.
the
variations
units)
point
in
Total
During
centre
weight
1800
the flight,
of gravity
kg for a centre
of
after
consumption
will
be 3.28
(Refer
Total
During
centre
weight
4000
the flight
of gravity
lb for a centre
after
consumption
will
be 130 in.
and CG limits
are given
in the
by the Supplements
corresponding
are
used
obtained
is
the
weight
fuel
to
easily
close
gravity
of 3.30 m.
of 200 kg of fuel,
to chart).
to
make
the
of
gravity
of 131 in.
of 600 lb of fuel,
the
(Refer
to chart).
LIMITATIONS
SECTION and may
to the oPtional
items
.
.R
35082
),
;.1:
6. 1
99-38
P:dg~
~
::: """.'
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
ABAQUE
DE CENTRAGE
LOADING
CHART
PILOTE
PILOT
. 55
PASSAGERAR.
REARPASSENGER
54
BANQ.BIPLACE
TWO-PLACE
SEAT
FRET CABINE
CABINFREIGHT
25g
w
CARGO
170
SOUTES
SIDEH
20;:!a;
0
~ARGOSWING
38
RESERV.CONV.
FERRY_~UEL
T1NK
32
',f;"
SaUTE AR.
REAR HOLD
.
60
1000
1100
1200
130
0> 140
~ 1500
0
iii 1600
$:
, 1700
w
~ 1800
~
~ 1900
2000
2100
2200
2300
~
2400
OD
0;
2509..
58
CENTRE
DE GRAVITE
-CENTER
OF GRAVITY
(m)
350 B2
99-38
,- ...,,;,
""I
,..co".'"!
.'.
C'o"""'"
6. 1
Page 8!
.
.
COMPLEMENTA~Y_FtICHT
ABAOUE
DE CENTRAGE
LOADING
MANUP
CHART
PILOTE
PILOT
PASSAGER
AR.
REARPASSENGER
BANQ.BIPLACE
TWO-PLACESEAT
FRET CABINE
CABIN FREIGHT
88.5 ~
CARGOSL
SOUTES
SIDEHO
CARGO SWING
RESERV.CONV.
FERRYFUEL TANK
SaUTE
REAR HOLD
AR.
2000
250
3000
I-
:I:
(!)
W 3500
:s:
w
cn
~ 4000
.4500
500
OJ
0
0;
t-
0;
"'
55
CENTRE
DE GRAVITE
-CENTER
OF
GRAVITY
35082
6. 1
89-17
---
(in)
Page 9
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
LATERALC.G.
The tables
below give the lateral
c.g. positions
for different
their moments with respect to the Y plane (positive
dimensions
right,
negative
dimensions on the left)"
5.1
weights
on the
and
; ~E~I:I~===r
-~:(==11==:=3
=:
:>
:>
,-
METRIC UNITS
WEIGHT
~
MOMENT:
m.k
A+
A-
8+
50
60
70
80
90
100
+
+
+
+
+
+
18
22
25
29
32
36
-18
-22
-25
-29
-32
-36
+
+
+
+
+
+
110
+ 40
-40
120
+ 43
-43
10
12
14
17
19
21
8-
C+
C-
0+
0-
-10
-12
-14
-17
-19
-21
+
+
+
+
+
+
31
37
43
50
56
62
-31
-37
-"43
-50
-56
-62
+
+
+
+
+
+
27
32
37
43
48
54
-27
-32
-37
-43
-48
-54
+ 23
--23
+ 68
-68
+ 59
-59
+ 25
-25
+ 75
-75
+ 64
-64
IMPERIAL
UNITS.
WEIGHT
lb
100
120
140
160
180
200
220
240
260
A+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
1417
1700
1984
2267
2551
2834
3117
3401
3684
A -B
-1417
-1700
-1984
-2267
-2551
-2834
-3117
-3401
-3684
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
815
978
1141
1304
1467
1630
1793
1956
2119
MOMENT: in.lb
B -C
+
-815
-978
-1141
-1304
-1467
-1630
-1793
-1956
-2119
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
R~
C -0
2445 -2445
2934 -2934
3423 -3423
3912 -3912
4401 -4401
4890 -4890
5379 -5379
5868 -5868
6357 -6357
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
2106
2528
2949
3370
3791
4213
4634
5055
5476
350 82
-2101
-2521
-294!
-337(
-379
-421
-463
-5055
-54~
6. 1
99-38
-"'
0-
Page 10
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
~,
5.2
Air
anDulance,
!!oist
and lateral
baaaaaeholds
+
-I
g'"
~
0
.;on
,,;
.METRIC
UNITS
WEIGHT
Kg
50
60
70
80
90
100
110
120
130
136
MOMENT: m.kg
A+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
18
22
25
29
32
36
40
43
47
49
A-18
-22
-25
-29
-32
-36
-40
-43
-47
-49
B+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
10
12
14
17
19
21
23
25
27
28
C+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
31
37
43
50
56
62
68
75
81
84
E-21
-25
-29
-33
-37
-41
-46
-50
-54
-56
F-77
-93
-108
-124
-139
-154
-170
-185
-201
-210
G+
+
+
+
+
+
+
28
33
39
44
50
56
G-28
-33
-39
-44
-50
-56
-61
-67
IMPERIAL UNITS
WEIGHT
lb
100
120
140
160
180
200
220
240
260
280
300
MOMENTSen in.lb
A+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
A-
1417 -1417
1700 -1700
1984 -1984
2267 -2267
2551 -2551
2834 -2834
3117 -3117
3401 -3401
3684 -3684
3968 -3968
4252 -4252
B+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
815
978
1141
1304
1467
1630
1793
1956
2119
2282
2445
C+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
2445
2934
3423
3912
4401
4890
5379
5868
6357
6846
7335
E-1634
-1961
-2287
-2614
-2941
-3268
-3595
-3921
-4248
-4575
-4902
F-6079
-7294
-8510
-9726
-10942
-12157
-13373
-14589
-15805
-17020
-18236
G+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
2189
2627
3065
3502
3940
4378
4816
35082
G-2189
-2627
-3065
-3502
-3940
-4378
-4816
-5254
-5691
~. 1
"
99-38
I,
Page 11
~j ~~
l, ._-
.;
~-
.,
c,.
5.3
Determination
of lateral
coo. location
The computation method is the same as that used for determining the
longitudinal
c.g. location (para. 4.1).
Add weights and moments to the aircraft
to preceding page.
Lateral c.g. location
permissible limits.
Exanq,le durina
hoistina
; ;~:'::
E'qoipped Empty Weight
.;;c-'i:j.~,J,;:i,ili
Pilot operator
:,~;:~;J ' "';:'5[; "'H'oist
;jft..;;"..,'"
."',.." ",~'"",.
,"", ',.
',to
Hoisted load
Fuel during hoisting
lateral
c.g.
location
within
within
1200
80
80
m Ka
+ 14
+ 29
-43
136
200
-210
1696
-210
~
= -0,124
1696
(ne
g0ative
moment:
hO1St
operator
located left to
aircraft
plane)
.
.
6. 1
89-17
';f:,
symmetry
350 82
"'-0
the
ooeration
Ka
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT
MANUAL
~:
"
Page 12
.
C~PlEMENTARYFlIGHT
MANUAL
6 WEIGHTANDMOMENT
OF EQUIPMENT
ITEMS
.
The following
approximate
list
weight
covers
the
and moment
optional
of the
equipment
items.
It
removable
components.
DESCRIPTION
m.ka
MOMENT
in.lb
2.1
4.6
3.2
275
1.1
2.4
1.7
149
Door + subdoor
14.0
30.9
27.2
2360
front
10.6
23.4
17.1
1484
7.3
16.1
11.5
998
21.1
46.5
54.6
4739
26.2
57.8
67.6
5867
2.3
5.1
2.6
225
Battery
17.3
38.1
69.0
5990
30.4
67.0
105.6
9165
23.6
52.0
82.4
7152
Skis "SURFAIR"
26.8
59.2
113.4
9871
67.6
148.8
227.5
19708
13.3
29.3
43.4
3771
44.8
98.9
35.0
77.2
82.3
7143
0.7
1.5
1.1
95
2.3
5.1
3.9
340
Aircraft
tool kit
Cabin fire
extinguisher
Axe
low front
seat
seat
Dual control
Emergencyfloatation
gear
for soft
ground
Ferry tank
Stretcher
R
R
.
15.1
33.3
26.7
350B2
2318
6. 1
99-38
---
the
WEIGHT
lb
ko
.High
gives
-.,-
::.
Page 13
'c-
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
DESCRIPTION
WEIGHT
lb
BREEZE electric
hoist 136 kg
(300 lb) (arm, winch, grip,
pulley-block,
belt,
shears)
26.0
57.4
68.4
5947
AIR EQUIPEMENTelectric
hoist
136 kg (300 lb) (arm, winch,
grip,
pulley-block,
belt,
shears)
33.4
73.7
87.9
7637
LOCATORsearch
10.1
22.3
9.3
809
42.9
94.5
145.6
12618
55.5
122.2
187.1
16189
Low landing
Hi~h
.
landlng
light
gear
gear
,,Footstep
WANDELAND GOLTERMANN
hailers
m.k
2.9
6.4
5.5
478
16.6
36.6
63.9
5548
35082
6. 1
99-38
MOMENT
in.lb
R
R
R
R
R
R
.
.
Page 14
" "
-COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 7
SYSTEMSAND DESCRIPTION
CONTENTS
7.0
LEADING PARTICULARS
7.1
COCKPIT
7.2
WARNING-CAUTION-ADVISORY
PANEL
7.3
POWERPLANT
7.4
FUEL SYSTEM
7. 5
ROTORAND TRANSMISSIONSYSTEMS
7.6
FLIGHT CONTROLS
7.7
HYDRAULIC SYSTEMS
7,8
ELECTRICAL POWERSYSTEMS
7.9
PITOT-STATIC SYSTEM
LIGHTING SYSTEMS
8'
N
35082
7.0.P6
99-38
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLJG_HTMANUAL
SECTION 7.0
LEADING PARTICULARS
1
':; --==:::::::::~~;~~==::~~:===
1
'0
,.,
..
~.,.,
,.,
.10.93m
(35.86rt)
~~i:~il~~~~~~~~
I'~E
~
..M
== ~
.:
~
~
It!
.
.
'"C!
t-
on
~
on
>
~
0
.t
when aircraft
12.94 m
10.69
3.02
10.93
2.53
3.14
0.39
1.87
10.93
42.45 ft
35.07
9.91
35.86
8.30
10.30
1.27
6.14
35.86
35082
7.0
89-17
""-"""-cC
~~ge 1
~ "
;;
:~
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
1.20m
O.8Sm
2.7811
E
0
0:
~
'" N
..: ~
..
:"""c!i~::-",
."}"'.;cc~'..:c
,'.~
~~:
~
'
'iC.
E -
...
O.93m
O.32m
O.42m
1.37ft
~
~
~
q
~
>'
~
1.12m
3.67ft
.. N
O.60m
1.96ft
BaQQaQe
compartmentareas
-Max.
length
-Max.
width
-Max.
height
-Available
floor
area
-Available
volume
2.42 m
7.94 ft
1.65 m
5.41 ft
1.30 m
4.26 ft
2.60 m2 27.98 sq.ft
-Rear
Cabin doors
-Forward
doors
Width
.Height
.Area
-LH hold
-RH hold
-Rear
hold
BaQQaQecompartment
1.12
1.10
1.29
m
3.67 ft
m
3.60 ft
m2 13.89 sq.ft
-LH hold
-RH hold
-Rear
hold
volumes
subdoors
.Width
.Height
.Area
0.60 m
1.10 m
0.69 m2
1.97 ft
3.60 ft
7.43 sq.ft
350 B2
7.0
99-38
{"'"
0,",
Page 2
"
COMPLEMENT~RY
FLIGHT MANUAL
ENGINE DATA
The aircraft
is equipped with an ARRIEL 1D1 modular-design
free-turbine
turboshaft
engine, mounted aft of the MGB in a separate fireproof
bay.
3.1 ~
-Direction
-Main
rotation
(viewed
looking
forward)
Clockwise
dimensions
Overall
.Overall
Overall
-Approximate
3.2
of
length
height
width
weight
1.200
0.465
0.612
m
m
m
of complete
47.24
1B.31
24.09
engine:
in
in
in
269 lb (122 kg)
Desiqn Characteristics
.The
engine comprises:
-a single-stage
axial compressor
-a centrifugal
compressor
-an
annular combustion chamber with centrifugal
fuel injection
and
ignition
-a two-stage
axial turbine
driving
the compressors
-a single-stage
free power turbine
-a hydraulic
governor using fuel as the motive fluid,
comprising:
.a free turbine
governor maintaining
constant Nf by modifying
the
Ng setpoint
of the gas generator
governor,
.a gas generator
governor controlling
the fuel flowrate.
TRANSMISSIONSYSTEMDATA
The main transmission
are the following:
-engine-to-MGB
coupling
shaft
-main
gearbox (MGB)
-two-piece
-tall
.c;,~"
gearbox
tail (TGB).
drive shaft
.~
.In
with
hydraulic
",ij , ,.,
pump drive
"'"
0,
rotors
pulley
.\i;;!!
," c.
""".~";,;c';-'
,
,.
!~;:!';"'.;;;";'o;i1
power-on fl~gh~'Fhe
rotor turn~ a~ a practically
constant speed 01
;:;:':
394 rpm. At thlS speed the transmlsslon
components rotate
at :
'"Co,'-42452
-6125
-2086
.R
shaft
rotor
350B2
7.0
99-38
Page 3
;~,
"
I
j
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
c{
1.
Fuel Quantity
Litre
Total
Usable after
of low-level
illuminatior
flight
Unusable
USGal. UK Gal.
540
143
119
60
15.8
13.1
1.25
0.33
kg
lb
Remarks
427
940
Specific
gravity:
0.79
47.4 104
0.28
2.20
LS&.= 0.79
CONVERSION
TABLE
GAUGE
READING
-CAPACITY
/WEIGHT
Graduation
10
9
.8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Litres
USGal.
UKGal.
540
486
432
378
324
270
216
162
108
54
0-3
143
129
114
100
86
74
57
43
29
14
0-0.8
119
107
95
83
71
59
48
36
24
12
0-0.6
.
kg
427
384
342
299
256
213
171
128
85
43
0-2.3
lb
940
846
752
658
564
470
376
282
188
94
0-5
system capacities
Lit res
UKGal.
MGBlubrication
system
6.5
1.7
1.4
TGBlubrication
system
0.33
0.08
0.07
6.2
1.64
1.36
0.79
0.66
Engine lubrication
Hydraulic system
system
350 B2
7.0
99-38
Page 4
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
.5
FUELTANKCAPACITY
Fuel Quantity
Litres
Total
.
.
Usable after
illumination
level light
US Gal.
540
143
UKGal.
119
kg
lb
427
940
RemarksI
Specific
gravity:
0.79
of low-
60
Unusable
15.8
1.25
0.33
13.1
0.28
47.4
104
2.20
s~.=
0.79
CONVERSION TABLE
GAUGE READING -CAPACITY /WEIGHT
Graduation
Litres
US Gal.
UK Gal.
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
540
486
432
378
324
270
216
162
108
54
0-3
143
129
114
100
86
74
57
43
29
14
0-0.8
119
107
95
83
71
59
48
36
24
12
0-0.6
kg
lb
427
384
342
299
256
213
171
128
85
43
0-2.3
940
846
752
658
564
470
376
282
188
94
0-5
HYDRAULICAND LUBRICATIONSYSTEMCAPACITIES
The hydraulic
and lubrication
system capacities
following table:
Litres
M.G.B. lubrication
T.G.B. lubrication
E!)!Jine lubrication
~raulic
svstem
svstem
system
system
6.5
0.33
6.2
3
US Gal.
1.7
0.08
1.64
0.79
UK Gal.
1.4
0.07
1.36
0.66
I
.350
B2
-~~
L
Page
5
7.0
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
.SEmON
7.1
~
This Section
is customized
.
.
N
.350
82
7 .1
92-12
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARYFLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION
7.2
WARNING-CA~~~SORY PANEL
This Section is customized
.
.
.350
82
7 .2
92-12
Page 1I
COMPLEMENTARYELIGHTMANUAL
SECTION7.3
.POWERPLANT
DESCRIPTION
1.1
Installation
The engine is mounted at the top of the body structure in a fireproof
bay. It is installed aft of the main gearbox, to which it is connected
by a shaft mounted between two flexible couplings.
1.2
Compressor Module
.Mounted
at the forward end of the engine, comprising a single-stage
axial compressor.
combustion
.generator
-Free
chamber
Turbine Module
At the aft
-Reduction
.Reduces
end, consisting
Gear Module
the free turbine speed from 41586 rpm to fOOOr~}
-Output
Shaft Module:
"'.
350 82
7 .3
99-38
Page 1
c,
,~
"'
:,-
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
OIL
SYSTEM
system basically
-Oil
tank
-Oil
cooler
-Pressurizing
pump
-Three scavenge pumps
-Oil
filter
assembly (filter,
lubrication
KEY TO FIGU!tE
OIL
Itew
DESCRIPTION
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Pressurizing pump
Pressure relief valve
Clogging indicator
Bypass valve
Oil filter
Pressure tap
Oil pressure indicator
8
9
Minimum oil
pressure
Scavenge
pumps
SYSTEM
Itew
DESCRIPTION
10
Non-return valve
11 Chip detection light
12 Oil cooler
13
Oil tank
14 Oil temperature indicator
15 .Torquemeter oil jet
16
Torquemeter transmitter
1 ight
17
Torquemeter
350
B2
89-17
.
7.3
.
Page 2
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
.1
.
.
L ..!.! -!-6
-r-;
0
q
13
Retour
11
-Oil
-Oil
-Oil
Couplemetre
17
0.-
12
Aspiration
Pression
:1 -,
10
suction
line
pressure
line
return
line
-Torquemeter
oil line
35082
,1.3
',c
89-17
jage 3
4:,si
.
,,""
s;
;'kc"""""
.~
:"
':'~,~
,?;;;;;
-,'
"C-'
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT
MANUAL.
ANQ INDICATOR
BLEED VALVE
FLAG
liNg
g
.;
ACTUAL Ng
>
s
:;~:.;:
~~ ,~; i:" -~
;;#i~~ThiS instrument'displays several indications:
-~:
The pointer
shows the difference
between the actual Ng value and the
"Ng at MAXT/O PWR", computed as a function
of altitude
and outside air
temperature.
The pointer
on graduation
"0" indicates
the computed "Ng at MAX T/O PWR".
-Gas
Qenerator
A flag
valve
shown as a digital
Ng is
equal to
value
position
on the instrument
.Black
the actual
speed
The actual Ng is
(in percentage).
-Bleed
that
indicates
flag
the position
of the
bleed valve:
: 'Valve closed
hatched
flag:
Valve open
A test push-button
is used to check the instrument operation.
In "test"
mode, the "Ng at MAXT/O PWR", computed as a function
of external
factors,
is displayed
as a digital
value in the window, and the ~Ng pointer
moves
and stops at zero.
:"
., .;~
350 B2
7 .3
99-38
.,;
~. ~-
Page 4
COMPLEMENTA~Y~LIGHT
~r:lUAL
SECTION7.4
.FUEL
SYSTEM
1
FUELTANK
Fuel is contained in a spin-molded polyamide fuel cell located in the body
structure beneath the transmission deck. It is equipped with a gravity
refuelling
spout on the LH side of the aircraft.
as well as a vent line and
a water bleed valve.
ENGINEFUELSUPPLYSYSTEM
Fuel is supplied from the fuel cell to the engine through the following
components in turn:
.-two
-a
fuel
-a
filter
filter
bypass valve.
FUELSYSTEM
CONTROLS
ANDMONITORING
The following
-a
-a
fuel
flow control
to the pilot:
-a
-a
-a
"FUEL" light
-a."F.
fllter
that illuminates
to indicate
,~
-a
"FUEL P.".light
200 rob at elther
in the tank
that
illuminates
wh~n t~e
pump or both pumps.'
,"
,:"-'
fuel
pr~ssure
is l~wer
..,i..
~ ~~ ~
35082
7(~
thaQ!~~
7.4
89-17
Page 1
'~;
::~"
~,
..
"
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
~c
\,
FUEL PUMP
4.
FUELPUMP
1
13
15
191
I ENGINE I
L_-J
j.
g
M
~
.,;
.,
FUELP
FUEL
F.FILT
22
23
>'
s
21
ITEM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
B
9
1D
11
12
13
DESCRIPTION
ITEM
Booster pumppush-buttons
14
Fuel contents indicator
15
Fuel pressure transmitter
16
Fuel pressure indicator
17
Fuel shutoff lever
18
Fuel flow control lever
19
Fuel shutoff valve
20
Fuel flow control valve
21
Engine
Differential
pressure switch 22
Filter bypass valve
23
Fuel filter
Fuel tank vent
DESCRIPTION
Refuelling spont
Fuel contents gauge
Fuel low level contactor
Fuel tank water bleed valve
Booster pump
Pumppressure switches
Check valve
Booster pumpfailure warning
light
Low fuel level warning light
Fuel filter
clogging early
warning light
R8I
35082
L
Page
2
7.4
99-38
~1'"
"""
it;,
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION7.5
ROTOR~~~MISSIONS
1
1.1
ROTORS
Main r-otor
The main r-otor- head and shaft tr-ansmlt M.G.8. r-otatlon and flight
controls motion to the main r-otor blades. As viewed fr-om the top, the
main r-otor tur-ns clockwise.
The STARFLEXtype seml-r-igld main r-otor- head is made fr-om new mater-ials
(resin glass fibre,
laminated thrust bearings, self-lubricating
bear-ings) allowing all conventional bearings and lubrication
systems to
be eliminated.
The three main r-otor blades of the glass-r-esin laminate flexible
construction
are attached to the rotor hub through flanges (1) and
star (2). Pitch var-iation is achieved thr-ough distortion
of elastomer
Items (3).
The vibration
dampening device (4) mounted in centre of the r-otor head
consists of a weight oscillating
between three springs fitted
120' apart.
i
I.
.350
82
7.5
89-17
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
1.2
Tail Rotor
~~ade
blades rotate
aircraft.
8
tail rotor is see-saw mounted on the T.G.B. The tail
anti-clockwise
as viewed from the right side of the
c"
rotor
TRANSMISSIONS
The transmission
system consists
of :
-engine-to-main
gearbox coupling system
-main gearboxO(M.G.B.)
-tail
rotor drive shaft
-tail
gearbox (T.G.B.).
2.1
Engine-to-M.G.B.
COupling
of three
interchangeable
-an epicyclic
reduction gear module (1)
providing a 4.33:1 reduction ratio;
-a
with five
bevel reduction gear module with a ring gear (3) and pinion (4)
providing a further 3.59:1 reduction ratio;
this module is housed in
two casings:
.main casing (5) supporting a power takeoff coup1ins (6)
.lower
casing (7) with M.G.B. mounting provisions ;
-a
lubrication
350
B2
7.5.
89-17
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
.~
5
.7
0
0
.;;:; .
.;"'
I
The gears and bearings are lubricated
by a pressurized
oil system. The
bottom (7) of the MGB casing is used as an oil tank and houses the
pu~.
The pump draws the oil through a strainer
and forces it to the oil
coolers.
After cooling,
the oil flows through the main filter
to the oil
jets.
A by-pass valve mounted on the main filter
allows the oil to flow
to the main gearbox when the filtering
elements are clogged.
lubrication
through:
-a
pressure
switch causing the "MGB. p" light
to illuminate
on the
warning-caution-advisory
panel when the pressure drops below 1 bar
(14.50 psi)
-a
thermal switch causing the "MGB. T" light
to illuminate
on the
warning-caution-advisory
panel when the temperature
reaches 115'C
-as
optional
equipment an MGB. oil pressure and temperature
indicator
can be fitted
in complement to the lubrication
monitoring
system.
-a magnetic plug that causes the "MGB CHIP "light
to illuminate
when
metal particles
are present.
.R
350 B2
99-38
1 .5
.'
f'age 3
;:J~":::
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
...
(0
ci
.,
>
ITEM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
DESCRIPTION
ITEM
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
DESCRIPTION
350 B2
7.5
99-38
-~.",
.
.
Page 4
COMPLEMENTARY FLIGHT
2.3
Tail
Rotor
Drive
System
The tail
rotor
drive
system transmits
power takeoff
to the tail
rotor.
It
consists
of two items:
rotation
-a
-a
output
bearing
forward
short
shaft
long
shaft
supported
Thes.
MAN~
at the engine
by five
ball
connected
to
each
other
from
the
engine
rear
assemblies.
by means
of flexible
couplings.
.6~~
c;
'/.o~
~
C;
.;
~
>
~
2.4
Tail
rotor
Rotor
2
3
4
Tail
gearbox
Tail
rotor
drive
Engine
6
7
8
Main rotor
head
Main gearbox
Oil
pump
Tail
Gearbox
The TGB is
(TGB)
a right-angle
drive
that
steps
the
rotational
speed
from
6125
is
Rotor
splash-lubricated
and
is
provided
with
an oil
level
sight.
LH lever
on
the
when
the
Brake
The rotor
brake
cockpit
control
is mechanically
Quadrant.
.is
shaft
brake
On brake
application,
the
thus
keeping
the friction
brings
the device
back to
moved
forward.
controlled
brake
by the
is
released;
lever
lever
causes a diaphragm
spring
to compress,
linings
under constant
load.
A return
spring
the "brake
released"
position
when the lever
35D B2
99-38
-~,5~:
78"
Page
+ff6
/- I ..
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION7.S
~-;;~
The flight
the pitch
ROLS
through variation
of
controls
consist
of three channels:
pitch
channel
controls are of the rigid tYpe (control rod) and the tail
are mixed (bal T tYpe control cabTes and rods).
and collective
autopilot
pitch
each channel is
.35082
7.6
89-17
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
16
~
'17
.,.
..
I
I tan
DESCRIPTION
I tan
Yawcontrol pedals
10
DESCRIPTION
28
3
11
Yaw servo-unit
128 Yaw channel actuator
Load-compensating
servo
4- Yawmovanentdetector
14-
Collective
lever
Ballflex
control
Main servo-units
Mixing unit
-Optional
lock
coupling
autopilot
Flight
Control Linkage
.350B2
7.6.
89-17
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGijT MANUAL
SECTION 7.7
.HYDRAULIC
SYSTEM
1
GENERAL
The hydraulic
hydraulically
The total
system fluid
volume is 3 lit res (0.79
up to the maximum level mark on the reservoir.
SYSTEMDESCRIPTION (Figure
The hydraulic
US gal.
or 0.66
UK gal.)
1)
system basically
includes
the following:
-A
-A
.system.
single-cylinder
yaw servo-control
(10) driving
the tail
rotor control
rod. In the event of a hydraulic
pressure failure,
a load compensating
is provided t? actuate
the c?ntrol
,~od with .acceptable
yaw ped~1 ;,;1~;;
operatlng
loads;
thlS system c~rlses:
::
~!:~;;"""'Z"
a
.,
hydraul
ic
accumu1ator
(4)
,:~
'"",,'.
system operating
"
pressure
is
40 bar.
.R
35082
7.7
99-38
--I
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
".
I
,.
3 SYSTEM
CONTROLS
ANDMONITORING
(Figure 1)
The pilot
low-pressure
by an aural
is informed of hydraulic
system fault
conditions
by a red "HYD"
warning light
(15)on ~he Warning-Caution-Advisory
Panel, and
alarm (14).
both of WhlCh are actuated by the pressure switch
unit.
console is used:
unit solenoid
is fitted
with
R
R~
350 82
7 .7
99-38
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
3 SYSTEM
CONTROLS
ANDMONITORING
(Figure 1)
Do not take into
()
warning light
check.
CAUTION:
"
0
350B2
7 .7
99-38
Page 2
*RC*
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
.1
,S
5 7
8 9
1
" c
.4
~
lii~
\..."
I
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
0
servo-con ro
Pitch servo-control
Roll servo-control
Hydraulic accumulator
Non-return valve
Solenoid valve
Pressure relief valve
Pressure- drop solenoid
valve
Load compensation servo
Yaw servo-control
Hydraulic pressure cutoff
switch
0 ectlve pl c
13 Accumulator test push-button
14" Horn
15
Low pressure warning light
16 Solenoid valve
17 Low pressure switch
18
Filter
19 Pressure regulator
20
Hydraulic pump
21
Hydraulic fluid reservoir
Figure 1
...CAUTION:
.INCORPORATION
OFMOD.072453.
;",'
350B2
7 .7
99-38
Page 3
*RC*
COMPLEMENTARY FlJGHT
MANUAL
11
.2
.3
~
;;
g
>
ITEM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
.Figure
DESCRIPTION
Roll
servo-control
Pitch
servo-control
Roll
servo-control
Hydraulic
accumulator
Non-return
valve
Solenoid
valve
Pressure
relief
valve
Pressuredrop solenoid
valve
Load compensation
servo
Yaw servo-control
Hydraulic
pressure
cutoff
switch
ITE~
DESCRIPTION
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
Collective
pitch
lever
Accumulator
test
push-button
Horn
Low pressure
warning
light
Solenoid
valve
Low pressure
switch
Filter
Pressure
regulator
Clogging
indicator
Hydraulic
pump
Hydraulic
fluid
reservoir
R
R
R
1
35082
7.7
99-38
Page 3
~"" ~
,; :;;
c,
:0"
:;:
=0=: ;:;
COMPLEMENTARYFLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 7.8
1 --;~~
1
SYSTEM
GENERAL
DC power is provided
by a starter-generator
mounted storage
battery.
A second
identical
storage
battery
and by a 16 anp-hr
may be installed
An external
power receptacle
on the R.H.
to supply the aircraft
electrical
system
side
fran
as optional
of the aircraft
a 28 VDC ground
equipment.
may be used
power unit.
The generator
and the battery
are coupled to the distribution
bus by means
of line contactors.
which can only close if the ground power unit
is
disconnected.
EXTERNAL POWERCIRCUIT
The ground power ~it
is coupled to
of its contactor
when the following
the primary
distribution
conditions
are met:
-electric
power is available
to the external
-the
NMASTER SWN pushbutton
is released
-the
.EXT PWR 8ATTN pushbutton
is depressed.
The -GENN and 8ATTN lights
buffer-
are
receptacle
illuminated.
The battery
and the generator
are
ground power unit
is disconnected.
power
bus by means
isolated
from
the system
until
the
BATTERY CIRCUIT
The battery
is coupled to the primary
contactor
when the following
conditions
distribution
are met:
-electric
power is not available
to the external
-the
-MASTER SWN pushbutton
is released
-the
-EXT PWR BATTN pushbutton
is engaged.
bus by means of
power
its
receptacle
The battery
may be isolated
from the aircraft
power system either
manually
(by means of the -MASTER SW- or -EXT PWR 8ATTN switches)
or automatica lly
(by connecting
a ground power un1t).
.350
B2
7.8
89-17
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
~
~
,JiJ'"
~~-
II~~.~
1
-15
E~Jl31
I
~~
z~
BS ~~
~~
1I-U
W'"
>(:3
UZ~"O:
;3~
~~ ';::::~ J ~~
I~~
~ou.~~AH
350
82
7.8.
89-17
Page 2
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT
.
MANUAL
4 GENERATOR
CIRCUIT
.
The generator
is coupled
to
contactor
when the following
the primary
conditions
distribution
are met:
bus
by means
of
its
-electric
power is not available to the external power receptacle
-the "MASTERSW", "CRANK"and "START"pushbuttons are released
-the "GEN" pushbutton is engaged
-the generator voltage exceeds the battery voltage by at least 0.5 V.
The generator may be isolated
power system:
illuminates
on the
5, ELECTRICAL
SYSTEM
CONTROL
ANDMONITORING
5.1
5.1.1
Console Pushbuttons
-"MASTER SW"
-"CRANK"
-"GEN"
-"RESET"
5.1.2
5.2
Indicator
Liqhts
The following
lights
-Red
light:
warning
Controls
"
"BAn
T"
,~,
I;
~I:
"'~'
"BAT"
"GEN"
!,
...,
'
Panel:
"," ,
;1'1'
Panel Indicators
-Anlnete
-Voltmeter
350 B2
7 .8
92-12
Page 3
-0'
--
t'1
;'
""
~
~
SECTION7.8
2--:~~~
~YSTEM
1
GENERAL
The AC power system is an optional
is equipped with an automatic pilot
Two different
types of installation
required.
AC power is
inverter
is
include
installation
required when the aircraft
or with certain
gyroscopic instruments.
are available,
depending on the power
supplied by a static
inverter
from the DC power system. The
located beneath the cabin floor.
Performance specifications
the following:
A.C.
28 VDC
115 and 26 VAC
400 Hz
150 VA ) limited
150 VA)
to 250 VA
power system
-Input
voltage
-Output
voltage
-Frequency
-Power
output
28 VDC
26 VAC
400 Hz
10 VA
DESCRIPTION OPERATION
The static
inverter
is supplied from bus bar PP9, through a fuse located on
the RH side fuse panel C16-amp. fuse for the 250-VApower system, 2.5-amp.
fuse for the 10-VA power system).
The system is switched
the control
panel.
AC power distribution
side fuse panel.
An amber caution light
A.C. power system.
on by means of
circuits
are protected
on the instrument
by fuses
panel
located
indicates
located
on
on the LH
a failure
350 82
of the
7 .8
99-38
.
R
R
Page 4
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MA~1UAL
.
.
0
r-;-;l
L:...:J
2 DESCRIPTION-OPERAIION
Do not into account the amber warning light
indicating
an ac generation failure.
.
on the instrument
panel
350 B2
~
i!5
7 .8
99-38
Page 4
*RC*
'
COlf'LEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION
7.9
PITO;=~~STEM
It consists of ;
-A total pressure circuit
-A static pressure c1rcuit
-Three flight
instrunents
.an a1rspeed Indicator
.a vertIcal speed Ind1cator
.an altimeter.
of the aircraft
centreline.
The static
pressure circuit
to the
supplies
the
three instrunents.
The tota 1 pressure port is mountedon the nose slightly to the left of the
aircraft centreline. It may include an optional heating resistor operated
by
-PI TOT- pushbutton on the
control console. A l1ght illuninates
on
thethe
Warning-Caut10n-Advisory
panel;
.
34.5
67
h '\
-)000
)00
0
0
=
..
.,
0
,;
%
.Item
10
DESCRIPTION
.PITOT. pushbutton
2
3
4
5
6
Wind1ng
Airspeed Indicator
Rate-of-cllmb
IndIcator
Altimeter
.PITOT- lIght
Item
7
8
9
10
DESCRIPTION
Warning-caution-advisory panel
Stat1c pressure port
Water bleed valves
PITOT head (with optional
heater)
AUTO-PILOTAIR DATACIRCUIT
When the aircraft
is fitted
an air
data unit
supplied
.350
82
7.9
89-17
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 7.10
A~~~ING
1
CABIN VENTILATION
Two separate
circuits
provide
ventilation
to
the cabin.
-Front
vent1lat1on
The air taken from the front
cabin area flows through two ducts and is
d1stributed
to the crew.
A pull-knob
on the instrl.lnent
panel controls
opening and adjustment
of the ventilation
circuit.
-Overhead
vent1lat1on
The air taken from the upper cabin area through
a ran air scoop is then
circulated
to the air outlets
via the structure
posts.
Air is d1ffused
by opening and orientation
of each air outlet.
.6
2
ItBn
1
2
3
OESCRIPTION
FRONT aerator
FRONT air outlets
Control
pull-knob
.350
ItBn
4
5
6
OESCRIPTION
Overhead a1r outlets
Ventilation
duct
Ran a1r scoop
B2
7.10
B9-17
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
tJ
2 HEATING. ANDDEMISTINGSYSTEM
These systans provide cabin heating
i;.c""
I
'
hot P2 air taken from the engine with air taken from under the floor.
The air mixture is circulated
through two separate circuits
to the heating
diffusers
provided under the front seats and to the danisting air
diffusers.
Two manually operated valves mounted on the P2 lines are used
to control air distribution.
~--.
.,-.
I tan
1
2
3
DESCRIPTION
Danisting air diffusers
Danisting control valve
P2 air ducts
Itan
4
5
DESCRIPTION
Heating control valve
Heating diffusers
.
.Optional
350
82
7.10.
89-17
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
B.1
CABIN
LIGHTING
No take in account:
"The rear dome light is supplied from the battery direct busbar and
controlled
by a switch on the overhead panel (emergency lighting)."
8'
'
"C'c
350B2
7. 11
99-38
Page 1
*RC*
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 7.11
.LIGHTING
1
CABIN LIGHTING
one
at
front
to
the
crew
and
other
at
rear
for
the
passengers.
unit
units.
Lamplighting
is
The cockpit dome light is directly supplied from the battery through two
circuits
and protected by a fuse. The cabin dome light is supplied
one circuit and protected by a fuse on the RH side fuse panel.
.through
The rear dome light is supplied from the battery direct busbar and
controlled by a switch on the overhead panel (emergency lighting).
2,
R
R
generator
:;~
~~!~:~t
co
:,"'
_:':::"
R
R
R
3S0B2
7 .11
99-38
Page 1
'
..
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUA
.8
5 LANDINGLIGHT
The 450 W searchlight
.The
'
TAXI LIGHT
150 W searchlight
CAUTION:
INCORPORATION
OF MOD.072488.
350 B2
7 .11
99-38
Page 3
*RC*
..'
ii
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
if
:',
PP6
2~ Y
30a
1a
4Y
PP5
~ a'y
~~
'y3
-.Do--
-.Do--
--::::::
===
11
::::::::::::-
12
10
13
.;
g
ci
ITEM DESCRIPTION
ITEM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
panel
8
9
10
11
12
13
DESCRIPTION
.
Console lighting
Push-button
lighting
Radio control
unit lighting
Light generator
Thennometer lighting
Stand-by compass lighting
and console
lighting
circuits
35082
7. 11
99-38
c"
!
R
R
R
R
R
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
POSITION LIGHTS
The aircraft
-one
-one
-one
is fitted
with
three
position
lights:
red light
on port end of the horizontal
stabilizer
green light
on starboard
end of the horizontal
stabilizer
white light at rear end of the fuselage.
The circuit
is protected
by two "POS. LT." fuses.
The installation
is controlled
by the "POS. LT."
the control
console.
push-button
ANTI-COLLISION LIGHT
The anti-collision
light
fitted
at the top of the vertical
the aircraft's
presence at a great distance.
R
R
on
The circuit
is protected
The anti-collision
light
the control console.
fin
indicates
R
R
on
S LANDING LIGHT
This light
makes approach and landing by night easier.
The 4S0-W landing light
is mounted on the RH side, below the cabin
R
R
It is controlled
by a LAND LIGHT push-button
on the control
console and is
protected
by two fuses (LAND. LT. CONT. and LAND LIGHT) provided on the
RH side panel.
R
R
R
TAXI L~GHT
This
light
improves
the safety
of the helicopter
when flying
near the
ground.
The lSO-W taxi
.
light
The light
is controlled
console
and is protected
provided
on the
3S0 82
R
control
R
R
7.11
99-38
"
.:1
!~~ ~,;
; : i ;,
c' ---"
--
I,
COMPLEMENTARY
FUC;HT MANUAL'
SECTION
8
SERVICING
.,c,
'!!
R
CONTENTS
Pages
8.1
GROUNOHANDLING
1
EQUIPMENTREQUIRED
HANDLING
8.2 SERVICING
INSTRUCTIONS
1
FUELS
FUEL ADDITIVES
LUBRICANTS
HYDRAULICFLUIDS
REFUELLING
4
"!!ii
it
,
8.3
'
TEST SHEETS
1
GENERAL
TEST SHEETS
'.
R
1
~
~ -2
8.4 DAILYOPERATING
CHECKS
1
OPERATIONIN COLDWEATHER
t'
;0 -.;0 ~ --1
t, f .I,'
~
~ --~
'"
--~
I
12
N
3S0B2
8.0.P6
99-38
Page 1
---I
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION8.1
G;;;;~ING
1
EQUIPMENT
REQUIRED
-For moving the aircraft
by hand:
.single
or twin handling wheels
.jacking
lever.
-For towing the aircraft
with a tractor:
the above-mentioned equipment. plus:
.a towing cable.
HANDLING
-Moving
the helicopter
by hand
On prepared ground
.Position
the ground hand1ing wheels on the mounting studs according to
aircraft
balance.
.Install
ground handling wheels (wheels outside skids. see Detail 8).
.Check that wheels are correctly
locked (see Detail A).
Lift the aircraft
onto its wheels using a jacking lever.
Lock in this position with retaining pins.
~~
.Use twin ground handling wheels.
Install
as described above.
-Towing
.
.
I
the helicopter
with a tractor
35082
8.1
89-17
Page 1
;'".
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
..
.
A
350
82
8.1.
89-17
Page2
--COMPLEMENTARY
I':LIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 8.2
.SERVICING
INSTRUCTIONS
1~
1.1
Conrnercial
DesiQnation
The authorized
The commercial
of Fuels
Manual.
1.2
R
R
R
Capacity
Litres
U.S.
Imp.
Gal.
Kg
lb
540
143
119
427
940
.Gal.
TOTAL FUEL
TANK CAPACITY
REMARKS
Specific
weight
= 0.79
NON-CONSUMABLE
FUEL
CONSUMABLE
FUEL
REMAINING WHEN
LIGHT COMESON
.
.obtained
1.25
0.33
0.28
2.20
13.1
47.4
104
.
..
60
15.8
FUEL ADDITIVES
The anti-ice
Specification
MIL-I-27686
MIL-I-85470.
The additive
additive
when used shall meet the requirements
of French
AIR 3652 or the equivalent
non-French specifications:
-D.Eng.
RD.2451 -PHILIPS
PFA 55 MB NATO code S748
.R
is to be mixed with
the fuel
in the following
-Minimum
.0.035
.0.06
concentration,
by volume :
% in a tank already filled
% in fuel to be used for refuelling.
-Maximum
concentration,
by volume:
proportions:
0.15 %.
If there exists
any doubt as to the
contents
of a fuel tank, the fuel is
replaced by fuel containing
a known
afore-mentioned
limits
unless it is
using a differential
refractometer.
concentration
of additive
in the
to be drained from the tank and
proportion
of additive
within
the
possible to measure the concentration
Instructions
concentration
permitting
the correct
are given by the vendor.
of additive
to be
350 B2
.8.2
c'
99-38
~age 1
~
,
---;f""';::'
--"',,,
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
*:
~.
.i
3 LUBRICANTS
3.1
EnQine Lubrication
3.1.1
Svstem
3.1.2
lubricants:
designations:
Capacity
Engine oil tank and system capacity:
or 1.36 Imp gal)II
3.2
R
R
6.2 litres
(1.64 US gal
Transmission Components:
"",;,:
\ ,
"
",-:;1[',.,3.2.1 Lubricants/CommercialDesignations
l~~JIIJfi~.~i
4.1
HYDRAULIC FLUIDS
fluids
4.2 ~
Total capacity of system; 3 1itres or 0.8 US gal or D.65 Imp gal.
Operating pressure;
40 bar (580 psi).
The warning light situated on warnin.g-caution-advisory panel illuminates
when pressure is lower than 30 bar (435 psi).
350 B2
8.2
99-38
.'.
,~,;;1'rf
Capacity
.
.
Page 2
.
.~
REFUELLING
~
(;
~
>
s
-Place
-Connect
the
helicopter
on a level
surface.
the bower earthling
cable
to the
Place
.Strictly
.Prohibit
the
quantity
electro-static
of
fuel
the following
safety
precautions:
that
the aircraft
electrical
power
a fire
extinguisher
near the work
prohibit
smoking
in the security
the use of any means of lighting
balance
remaining
supply
is
in
the
switched
area.
area.
not confonning
connector
tanks.
off.
to
the
rules
of safety.
.Ensure,
during
refuelling
(or
defuelling
unit)
is connected
defuelling)
, that
the bower (or the
to the aircraft
by the electro-static
balance
.Strictly
fuel
-Fill
inside
the
flowmeter.
-Position
-Disconnect
connectors.
prohibit
draining
a hangar
or shop.
tanks,
monitoring
and lock
the filler
the bower earthling
balance
connector
(1).
-Check
that
the difference
to the quantity
of fuel
.R
of
the
quantity
tanks,
of
whether
fuel
partial
delivered
plug
(2),
using
the key.
connector
from the aircraft
in the
delivered
aircraft
fuel
and detennine
or total,
on the
electro-static
gauge readings
corresponds
the corresponding
weight.
350 82
8.2
99-38
bower
Page
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
Refuellino
WARNING:
-Strictly
comply with the instructions
defined below.
-Head aircraft
into forward wind sector + 45. if wind above 10 kt.
-Lock
the collective
pitch lever in full-low
pitch position.
-Check main rotor is at nominal speed with fuel flow control
in flight
detent.
-Limit
refuelling
at 95% in order to prevent any fuel spillage.
-The
pilot
must have someone well in sight to signal the mechanic to stop
refuelling.
-After
refuelling
give the filler
plug key to the pilot.
[8
R
R
R
350 B2
8.2
99-38
:i
..,'.
.
.
Page 4
.
.
COMPLEMENTARYFLIGHT MANUAL
Refuelling
~
with
rotors
turning
-Strictly
canply with the instructions
defined below.
-Head aircraft
into forward wind sector + 45' if wind above 10 kt.
-Lock the collective
pitch lever in full-low
pitch position.
-Check main rotor is at nominal speed with fuel flow control in flight
detent.
-Limit
refuelling
at 95'1. in order to prevent any fuel spillage.
-The pilot must have someone well in sight to signal the mechanic to stop
refuelling.
-After
refuelling
give the filler
plug key to the pilot.
5
DAILY CHECKS
Information
Master Servicing
Recommendations, is detailed
concerning
the
daily
check,
prescribed
in the
doclRnents available.
.
.350
B2
8,2
89-17
Page 5l-
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION8.3
.TEST
SHEETS
1
GENERAL
The test sheets are intended to sum up the checks to be carried
out in
flight
or on the ground, with rotors turning
either
after
replacement of
major components, or after an extensive
operation,
or further
to periodic
inspections.
The test
be filled
CAUTION:
.!';;
sheets
,.
.R
350 B2
8.3
99-38
Page 1
c-"",;
i_c,
"'1";'J
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT
MANUAL
--
N 0
FLIGIrr REPORT
N 1
N 2
N 3
N 4
N 4 A
N 5
N 6
N 7
SYSTEM CHECKS
OPERATIONS
ONENGINE
ORMODULE
REPLACED.
.Engine
Engine
TEST
Removal! replacer
II
"
nsta atloln ment
Hydro-
Module Replacement
mechanical
governor
repacement.
I
No 1-5
No.. 2 3
No 4
Hover
Flight ..
Starting
Ground Run
Bleed
Valve.
..
Acceleration
condition
Engine
Power
Check
NgatMax.
T/O
PWR
or
Static
droop
..
check
coast.down
Engine
35082
8.3
99-38
-~-~-
Page
...C().4PLEMENTAR,Y:_~IGHT
MANUA
I
.0
AS 350
FLIGHTREPORT
,
DATE:
CREW
Start:
Durati on
AREA:
QFE:
QMU:
QAN:
Numberof landings:
WEATHER'
.Direction:
.Force
:
:
:
:
.~~O~~-~I~~-:::::::::::::::
CGLOCAnON
:
.UNITS
REMARKS MADE BY
CREW AFTER FLIGHT
USED
(cr~ outas applicable)
WEIGHT
kg
FUEL
-Ib
kg -Ib
-I
SPECIAL INSI'ALLA110NS
ALTITUDE
.%
m.
ft
AIRSPEED
km/h
-kt
.MPH
WRrIER'SVlSA
.R
350 82
.99-38
8.3
"';page 3
..
~, -.
~---
-COMPLEMENTARY
SHEET No"
HELICOPTER
CHECKS AFIER
ENGINE
.
.
OR MODULE
REPLACEMENT
AS 350
FLIGHTMANUA"L
Enginestarting-Groundrun
RESULTS TO BE
OBTAINDED OR
LIMITATIONS
RESULTS
OBTAINED
ENGINESTARnNG
Comply with the Nonna!
Procedures of the Flight
Manual, SECTION 4.1.
Hpl
I OAT I
4"'"
:- B;'ttery vOlta;
-Bo'()ster(s) pump ON
::'
'1
Voltage = 25 V Approx.
.Pressure greater than 0.4 bar
U:
Pressure:
I
I
I
I
Starter ON
.Battery
U:
Check:
Max. t4 :
t4 :
voltage ~ 18 V
.M:840C
(5 sec. max. above 7750 C)
Other versions:
7950 C
8650 C (less than 5 sec.)
The GEN. light goes out
before Ng is 50 %.
The ENG.P.light goes out
before Ng is 70 %.
Record parameters at flight
idle rating:
I Correct I
I Incorrect I
I Correct I
I Incorrect I
ANg*
.g
N
14
~rquemeterponteringreen
.J"
Focipress.
Oil~s.
Oiltemp.
Nf**
NR
'B2version
..Except
Synchronization of NR/Nf
pointers::!: 3 rpm
BA-BB velSions
I Correct I
I Incorrect I
35082
8.3
99-38
Page 4
~
r..:
..C(O!PI.EMENTA~Y
.SHEEr
No.
HELICOPTER
AS
350
_fI.IGH"J:C;MANUAI.
REPLACEMENT
RESULTS OBTAINED
SYSTEMCHECK
Switch off boosterpump(s).
No Ng ort4 hunting.
Switch on :
-350 BA-BB : boosterpump, Correctoperationof the
-Other versions: booster
pumps
pumpsone after the other,
I C4IITeI:tI
I Incorrect I
I Corrt I
I Incorrect I
I Corrt I
I Incorrt I
separately.
Check injection safety
No engineflame-out.
system:
Pr~ the starterpushbuttonat
Ng equalto or more than70 %
CHECKAFI'ER
GOVERNOR
..
REPLACEMENT
I Correct I
acceleration.
Repeatthis operationonce
more.
ENGINE SHUT-DOWN
I Incorrect I
,~
.
..
,c~
.,:
Checkthe enginegenerator
coast;downtime, after
30 seconds'stabilization
at Ng between67 and 72 %
Coast-down
time from
Ng = 30 % : equalto or more
than 30sec.
I c..rrect I
!Incorrect I
I Correct I
I IncOlCrect
I
.R
35082
8.3
99-38
Page 5
!!' -
~-
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT
MANU~L
..:~
;':.
HELICOPTER
SHEET
No.
AS
350
RFSULTS OBTAINED
LIMITA TIONS
HOVER IGE (6 ft)
All air bleedsshutoff:
Recordparameters
.Refer to Limitations, in
Flight Manual,
Hp I
I OAT I
SECTION
2.1.
bNg*
Ng
t4
Fuelpress.
Oil press.
Oiltemp.
Nf**
NR
.B2 V..s;on
** ExceptBA-BB versions
Fuel
contents
ENGINE ACCELERATION
Aircraft on the ground.
Increasepitch from full low
pitch to hover IGE flight pitch -No enginesurge
within 2 to 3 sec.
.Min. transientNR : more
than360 rpm
-t4less thanmax .t4
I Correct I
I IncorrectI
I Correct I
I IncorrectI
I Correct I
!lncorrect I
350 82
~99-38 Page
6
8.3
"
.
.
..COMPLEMENTARY
S~
No.
FLIGHT/MANI
HELICOPTER
AS 350
REPLACEMENT
RESULTS OBTAINED
LIMIT AnONS
LEVEL FLIGHT AT MAX.
CONTINUOUS POWER
Altitude equal to or less than
3000 ft
All air bleedsshutoff.
Engine
complycondition
with the Right
check:
Manual
SECTION4.2.
Recordparameters:
Hp II
OAT c:=J
ANg*
Ng
t4
Fuel press.
REMINDER:
Oil press.
Oil temp.
NR = 393rpm :!:1
Nf**
NR
.B2 V.,.;on
Enginecondition: refer to
Manual, SECTION4.2.
.Flight
..Except
BA-BB velSions
!AS:
I Correct I
[~~!J
"
BLEED VALVE
OPERATION CHECK
.,.
"
See TURBOMECA
MaintenanceManual
!AS :55kt
Actuatethe collective pitch
lever to obtainclosing then
opening of thebleed valve
I Corrt I
IlIM:orrectI
.R
35082
8.3
99-38
Page 7
-_.~
~'"
-'-c.
..
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
'.
HELICOPTER
CHECKS
AFTER
SHEET No.
1
AS
TEST
PHASES
350
Level
AND
RESULTS
REQUIREMENTS
TO
IN
LEVEL
FLIGHT
AT
valve
All
to
air
the
be
condition
BE
RESULTS
OBTAINED
nONS
MAX.
and
high
discharge
closed.
bleeds
Record
Engine
at usual
altitude
for
MODULE
POWER
be perfonned
operational
enough
OR
ALTmmE
CONTINUOUS
To
flight.
OBTAINDED
OR
LIMITA
CHECK
ENGINE
REPLACEMENT
shut
off.
parameters:
RefertoLimitations,
in
Flight
Hp
OAT
Manual,
SECTION
2.1.
ANg*
Ng
t4
"
'
Fuelpress.
on
press.
on
temp.
Nf**
NR
ENGINE
.B2 Yozsion
..'ExceptBA-BBversions
GOVERNOR
AtIAS=65kt:
-Recuce
fo
the
full
fine
pitch
from
MCP
pitch.
.No
engine
.ENG.P
flame-out.
light
does
not
NR
max.
Correct
Incorrt
COITed
Incorrect
illuminate.
.Comply
with
limitation.
-In
2 to
3 sec.,
increase
pitch.
fromre-synchronization
(NR
= 395
rpm
No
.Min.
approx.)
to
Max.Continuous
Power.
engine
NR
surge
more
than
360
rpm
.t4lessthant4max.
350
?
,
,
82
8.3
99-38
c;:.".;
?~~,
c
;,. ..-;
Page
.
8
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SHEEr
No.
HELICOPTER
AS
350
TESTPHASESAND
REQUIREMENTS
RESULTSTO BE
OBTAINDED OR
LIMITATIONS
RFSULTS OBTAINED
CHECK
c.:;
power.
~;~
.exceeding
.All
: In orderto avoid
thetorque
limitation, it may be
necessaryto climb.
air bleedsshut-off.
Recordparameters:
..~,
SECrION 2.1.
I OAT I
Ng
14
"Ii
.
.
350B2
8.3
99-38
Page 8M
HELICOPIER
SHEEr
No.
AS
350
~T
PHASES AND
REQUIREMENTS
COMPLEMENIARY_~X~HJc~~
REPLACEMENT
RESULTS OBTAINED
Aircraft on theground.
Full low pitch.
BLADE TRACK
Recordbladetrack.
UNBALANCE
~:
The unbalanceis to
becheckedonly
afterobtaininga
correctbladetrack.
Recordunbalance
(Accelerometeron baseof
MGB flared housing).
'r_~
..",
.'
Unbalanceequalto or
lessthan:
aircraft with low UG : 0.2 ips
aircraft with high UG : 0.3 ips
Finalresultobtained:
ips
I
Time
I
Numberof balancingplates:
"'",,; '!
,~ii~!~S :!:!i;t
..:,
R
B
.R
35082
8.3
99-38
Page 9
~~,.
'7'"
.COMPLEMENTARY:LIGHT
HELICOP1ER
SHEEr
CHECKS
No.
AFfER
MRH,
AS
350
TEST PHASESAND
REQUIREMENTS
IGE
Record
FREQUENCY
REPLACEMENT
Hover
HOVER
MANUAL
Flight
RESULTSTO BE
OBTAINDEDOR
LIMITATIONS
IGE
RESULTSOBTAINED
(6 ft)
shut off.
Manual,
SECfION
2.1.
parameters:
Refer to Limitations
in Hight
Hp
I OAT
ANg*
Ng
t4
J"
Nt"*
NR
.B2 V.,.;on
..Except BA-BB versions
Fuel
conlmts
Deviation
adjustbladetrack.
Check and, if necessary,
adjust unbalance.
Unbalance
ips
Time
350 82
8.3
99-38
--
Page 10
i.
I...
.C<*PLEMENTARY
FLIGHT
MANuAL
,.
-c
HELICOPTER
SHEEr
2
No.
ADAPTER
ORMAIN ROTORBLADE
AS
350
REPLACEMENT
TEST PHASESAND
REQUIREMENTS
RESULTSTO BE
OBTAINDEDOR
RESULTSOBTAINED
LIMITATIONS
Level flight atMax.
ContinuousPower.
AItitude equalto or less than
3000ft.
AIl air bleedsshutoff.
Recordparameters:
.Manual,
Hp c::=J
OAT c:=J
ilNg*
REMINDER:
Ng
NR: 393rpm.:!; I
14
.J""
Nf**
~
.82 Vcrsioll
..Except BA-BB
vasions
Fu
con
Checkperformancedata:
lAS: I
.
Recordthe blade track andthe
value given by the aircraftnose
accelerometer:
a) lnstabiliredlevel flight at
Max. ContinuousPower
yziIilevel flight:
ips
I
.R
T1Ule
I
35082
8.3
99-38
..-
Page 11
"
.CI*:lEJIEJITA"
HELICOPTER
SHEET
No.
FLIGHT
MAN~A
-
AS
350
TEST PHASESAND
REQUIREMENTS
b)In 450turn,atthespeed
corresponding
to levelflight
atMax.Continuous
Power
.Blade trackdeviation:equal
to orlessthan12mm
i
.yz;(a/cnose):equaltoor
yz;in45tum:
lessthan0.35ips
ips
I
c)Fromlevelflight atMax.
Continuous
Power,
accelerate,
atconstant
power,upto VNE
Time
.No signifcant
variationofthe
vibratory
level.
d)Record3 .0.Pvibration
level. .3.0. Ppeaklevel: equalto or
I CorrectI
Usinganaccelerometer
lessthan0.2g (or 0.62ips
placedonhe flooralongthe forNR394rpm).
aircraftZ datumline,atthe
frontofthepilot'sseat,
~:
lftheresultisincorrect,
recordthevibratorylevelin
ie. if thelevelishigher
levelflight atMax.
than0.2g; theadjustContinuous Power.
I IncorrectI
checked.
35082
-.99-38
-~~,:;
.
,;'-"of
8.3
Page 12
,~
..COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
)~. .f"
HEUCOPTER
SHEET
2
No.
AS
TEST PHASESAND
REQUIREMENTS
.CHECK
350
RESULTSTO BE
OBTAINDED OR
LIMITATIONS
RESULTS OBTAINED
OF MAX. NR
Altitude greaterthan5000 ft
In autorotation,with collective
REMINDER:
pitch lever againstlow pitch
stopand IAS = 65 kt :
3..iQ..R2..:
Progressivelyincreasetheload WarningMax. NR : 410 rpm
factor, if necessary(pull-upor
turnto the]eft), in order tobring Max. NR : 430 rpm
therotor speed,transiently,to
theauralwarningthreshold(B2)
or to 4]0 rpm (BA, BB, B1,L]). .No significantvariationof the
.vibratory
levelduring or after
themanoeuvre(unbalance)
I Corra:t I
[lJM:orra:tI
[Corra:t
I IncorrectI
.
...R
35082
~.3
.99-38
Page 13
11
C"
::
.,
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
HELICOPTER
SHEET
No.
AS
350
TEST PHASESAND
REQUIREMENTS
HIGH ALTITUDE
Recommended
accordingto
thetypeofoperation.
!:evelflightatMax.Continuous
POwer.
7; "
A'ltirudeabout10000ft (or
max. altitudecompatiblewith
the operationalconstraints).
RefertoLimitationsin Flight
Manual,SECTION
2.1.
Hp r--1
OAT I
4Ng.
Ng
REMINDER:
NR : 393rpm:Z.1
14
,t
Np.
NR
.B2Venion
..Ex~t
BA-BB v...x.ns
Fuel
contents
Checkperformance
data:
10 (B2)
35082
8.3
99-38
rj(~~-;'C
,ft,
Page 14
-I,,~-
.COMPLEMENTARX
FlIGijTMANUAL
HELICOPTER
.SHEEr
No.
2
AS
350
TEST PHASESAND
REQUIREMENTS
RESULTSTO BE
OBTAINDEDOR
LIMITATIONS
RESULTSOBTAINED
rz in level flight:
[=::::J C=:J
b)In 300turn, at thespeed
correspondingto level flight
atMax. ContinuousPower
.No significantvariation of
thevibratorylevel.
I CoiT~t I
I htc:OFr~tI
I CoIT~t I
Ilncorr~t I
VNE.
.,j;.,
io,
:; ;!::
,-,.~f;
.N
35082
8.3
99-38
Page IS
"
..,"-""""""
J."
.,
COMPLEMENTARY FLIGHT
MANUAL
~1
SHEET
No.
3
AS
'lmT
CHECKS
AFTER
MGB
REPLACEMENT
.
HELICOP1ER
PHASES
350
Groundnm-HoverOight
AND
RESULTS
REQUIREMENTS
TO
BE
OBTAINED
OR
~ULTS
OBTAINED
LIMITATIONS
Stan
engine
the Normal
Flight
as prescribed
Procedures
Manual,
Engage
in
of the
SEC110N
"HORN"
4. I.
pushbutton
MGB.P
warning
for NR
less
than
200
less
than
110 rpm
Aural
for
and 360
5 to
flightIGE
10 minutes'
(6 ft) ata
approaching
goes
out
NR
(warm)
(cold)
Correct
!Incorrect!
Correct
(Incorrect
continuous
between
250
rpm.
RefertoLimitationsinFlight
Manual,
SEC110N
Hp
I)
OAT
2.1.
the maximum
takeoff
weight.
Refoc
to Flight
SEC110N
hover
weight
rpm
warning
sound
Perform
light
f.Ng*
Manual,
Ng
5.1.
t4
J"
MGBoiI
temp.**
MGBoiI
.press.**
NR
* B2
**
Vmion
Optional
Fuel
-contents
Warning
lights:
MGB.P
Correct
I Incorrect
MGB.T
must
Engine
Rotor
and rotor
brake
from
remain
off.
shut-down
170 rpm
t equal
to or less
than
25 ~.
t:
350 B2
8.3
99-38
;0. ,
--.
Page
.
16
."COMPLEMENTARY
",
:t
I.
~~LIC;HT
MANUA
HELICOPTER
.SHEEr
BLADEREPLACEMENT
AS
350
REQUIREMENTS
CHECKS AFTER
No.
Ground
run.TRHunbalance
RFSUL TS TO BE
OBTAINED
OR
RESULTSOBTAINED
LIMIT A nONS
CHECKOF1RH
UNBALANCE
Aircraft on the ground.
ips
I
I
Time
I I
I I
I
I
.
Make required corrections.
Chordwise balancing:
Recordings
Sector A
Sector B
"
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Spanwisebalancing:
Recordings
.Blade
.Blade
When unbalance at NR =
270 rpm is less than I ips,
increase rotor speed up to
flight idle.
The correction to beapplied
sha1lbe a compromise between
the values found at the two
rotor speeds to obtain an
unbalance of less than 0.35 ips.
."N
ips
I
35082
8.3
99-38
"
Page 17
.."
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SHEEr No.
4 A
HELICOP1ER
AS
350
TESTPHASES
AND
.I
REQUIREMENTS
CHECKS
AFTER
TAn..ROTOR
DRIVE
SHAFT
REPLACEMENT
Tailrotordriveshaftbalancing
RESULTS
TOBE
OBTAINED
LIMITA
OR
RESULTS
OBTAINED
nONS
Aircraftontheground.
Fulllowpitch.
Record
theunbalance
Unbalance
lessthan0.8ips.
Unbalance:
value
.I
ips
II I.
Time
35082
8.3
99-38
'",
.
.
Page 18
..~
COMPLEME~T
HELICOP1ER
SHEET
No.
AS 350
ON
Hydraulicdlecks
RESULTS TO BE
OBTAINED OR
LIMIT AnONS
RESULTS OBTAINED
Stanengineasprescribedin
the Normal Proceduresof the HYD warning light goesout
Flight Manual, SECTION4.1. for NR :
lessthan200rpm (warm)
lessthan110rpm (cold)
Aircraft on theground.
Full low pitch,collective lever
I Correct I
IlIKorrect I
I Correct I
I IncOl'rectI
I Correct I
IlIKorrect I
I Correct I
IlIKorrect I
I Correct I
IlIKorrect I
I Correct I
IlIKorrect I
locked.
Test accumulatorsof main
servo-units:
Pressthe TEST HYD
pushbutton
The auralwarningkeeps
soundingaslong asHYD
warning light stayson
(2 to 3 sec.).
..N
35082
8.3
99-38
Page 19.
~" "
I:,,_'"~"'~
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
HELICOPTER
SHEET
5
No.
AS
TFST PHASESAND
REQUIREMENTS
ADJUSTMENTOFTHE
LOWprrCH STOP
350
CHECKSAFfER OPERAnONS ON
FLYING CONTROLS
RESULTSOBTAINED
LIMrrAllONS:
Max.NR : 430rpm.
Altitudelowerthan5000ft
Performautorotation
with
collective lever againstlow
pitchstop.
IAS : 65kt
OOIE: Selecttheweightandaltitudevalueswhichallowan NRbetween
395and415rpm
to beobtained
atfull lowpitch.
Do notpullbackthefuelflow controllever.
Recordthe following
Hp
parameters:
OAT
NR in compliance
with the
valuescomputed
bymeansof
Figure 1 + 0 rpm
+ 10
Fuelcontents
Computed
weight
NR obtained
DesignNR
.
.
I
35082
8.3
99-38
Page 20
.-'
-COMPLEMENTARY
SHEET No.
5'
HELICOP1ER
AS
350
-'
FLIGHT
MANUAL
CHECKSAFfER OPERAll0NS ON
FLYINGCONTROLS
Check
ofthelowpitdlstopadjustment
30
20
1.
(trim in)
(rpm)
00
80
60
.340
320
50
40
30
20
10 ~
0
}.<
0
-10 0
(D
-20
0
0
,.,
-30
ci
~
s
-40
FIGURE 1
.N
35082
8.3
99-38
Page 21
--w",,-
I
~
i
'....COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT
MANUAL
0-
ct
SHEET
No.
FLYING
CONTROLS
.
HELICOP1ER
AS
CHECKS
350
AFTER
OPERA nONS
ON
RESULTS TO BE
OBTAINED OR
LIMITAnONS
RESULTS
OBTAINED
Manual,
SECllON
2.1.
Hp c=:J
OAT ~
~Ng*
Ng
.~
REMINDER:
t4
NR: 393rpm:t I
Nf**
NR
.B2
Version
..ExceptBA-BB
v-ions
Fuel
contents
IAS
Vibratory level
I Correct I
IlDCOI'rect
I
350 82
8.3
99-38
.
.
Page 22
.
.
..COMP~EMENTARY
P
r
I c,
f.
_FLIGHT
MAN
HELICOP1ER
SHEEr
6
No.
AS
CHECKAFTERGENERA
TOROR
ELECTRICALMASTERBOX REPLACEMENT
350
RESULTS TO BE
REQUIREMENTS
OBTAINED
OR
RESULTS
OBTAINED
LIMITATIONS
ENGINE AT FLIGHf IDLE
RATING
BATT switch OFF.
Check GEN. voltage
U = 28.5 V approx.
CUT
Operate
OUT
thepushbutton
EMERG.
All
350power
BA -BB
supplies
:
are cut off,
I CAlrrect I
I IncorrKt I
I ~t
I Incorrect I
I ~t
I Incorrect I
I CAlrrect I
I Incorrect I
except:
Ng, t4, NR, forward dome
light
,
350BI-Ll:
except:
Ng, NR, forward dome light
~:
All power supplies are cut off,
except:
..
I
.N
35082
8.3
,
99-38
.!
Page 23
"
.
.
HELICOP1ER
SHEET
No.
SYSTEMCHECKS
AS 350
20
07
07
501
-Radio-navigation
20 07
07
502
20
07
07
503
20 07
07
504
.-Navigation
-Autopilot andassociatedcouplings
I
35082
8.3
99-38
-~
c"
,--ii,
f
"
.
.
Page 24
COMPLEMENTARYF~rGHT
MANUAL
SECTION
8.4
.DAILY
OPERATINGCHECKS
The daily checks must be conducted in accordance with standard aircraft
practices
and the appropriate
manufacturer's
recommendations,
by Qualified
maintenance personnel or by a specially
trained
pilot.
Any alteration
or
detailed
inspection
to determine serviceability
as a result of these checks
must be done under the supervision
of a properly
endorsed Aircraft
Maintenance Engineer and duly entered in the Aircraft
Log Book.
R
R
NOTE:
R
R
Some certification
from the operators.
may require
specific
Qualifications
1:1
authorities
helicopter
operation
requires
three
checks:
Checks Before
The First
FliGht
~:
IF THE AIRCRAFT HAS BEEN GROUNDED
FOR MORETHAN ONE WEEK, BEFORE
OPERATINGTHE FLYING CONTROLS,WIPE THE SERVO-CONTROLPISTON RODS WITH
A RAG IMPREGNATEDWITH SERVICE FLUID.
-Check that the area is clean and clear.
-Remove the blade socks, if applicable.
-Perform
the following
checks.
.4
.'
1
~
~
.N
I \.
3_1d.. /'
350 B2
8.4
99-38
Page 1
II
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
.
STATION 1
-Transparent
-P~tot
-Sldesllp
panels
Cleanliness
vents
...Blan~i~g
Condltlon
cover,
drain
removed
STATION 2
-Engine
air intake
-Tail
pipe cover
-MGB
-Open the engine cowling:
.Transmission
deck and engine..
-Fuel
tank
-Filler
cap
-LH baggage compartment door
-Lower
cowlings
-Af~
baggage compartment
-Maln
rotor blades
Blanking cover
Removed
Oil level
Condition,
Purge
Closed
Loads tied
Closed
No foreign
No dents
removed
cleanliness
down,
matter,
door locked
closed
STATION 3
-Tail
-TGB
-Tail
guard
(if
fitted)
Security
Oil level
...Condition,
security
STATION 4
-Tail
-Tail
rotor blades
boom and TGB fairings
Condition
Security
of skin
STATION 5
-RH baggage compartment
.Battery
.Loads
."
Open
Connection
Tied down,
Close and Jock compartment
...Closed
-Ground
power receptacle
door
-Engine
compartment:
Transmission
deck and engine..
.Engine
oil tank
.Close
the engine cowling.
R
Condition,
Oil level
Correctly
cleanliness
locked
STATION 6
-Collective
pitch control
and yaw pedals
",.",."."
-Gas generator
control
-Rotor
brake control
-Fuel
shut-off
control
-Fire
extinguisher
Free travel
Free movement
Free movement
Forward position,
In place
snap wire
350 82
fitted
8.4
99-3B
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARY
Fl,JGHT MANUAL
1.2
1.2.1
Check after
the
Last FliQht
General
attention
aircraft
flightworthy.
It consists
in carrying
examination
of the condition
of a component, an
defects which could affect
correct
operation.
use of any special techniques
or tooling.
to
the elements
marked with
an asterisk
"*".
1.2.2
during
ALF check
R
R
R
R
R
R
STATION1
R
R
-All
transparent
panels
Cleanliness
(clean if
-Door
jambs, canopy arch members. No faults
nor cracks
-Cabin
access door
Security
and correctly
-Pitot
heads and static
vents ...Fit
blanking covers
required)
locked
.N
350 82
8.4
99-38
e:age 3
(
?'
~ :
-
"~
.
i
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANU~L
~o
,{
,:
*'
STATION
2
-lH
baggage compartment
door
Condition,
objects
-LH
landing
gear
.'...'..'
.Shock absorber
.Wear resistance
plate
-MGB cowlings
-MGB oil
-Transmission
deck
-MGB suspension bars
-Servo-controls,
hydraulic
system
-DUNLOP servo-controls
-Hydraulic
filter
-Hydraulic
reservoir
-Coo1in~
fan
-Fuel
fl1ter
-Universal
joint
assembly
'..
security,
tied
down,
open,
close
Condition,
absence of leaks
Condition
Open: condition
of locking
Check level
Cleanliness
Security
lock
Ifj
R
R
systems
Security,
no leaks, lines
Security,
no leaks, no cracks on
R
the body leading to seepage
R
Clogging indicator
(if fitted)
not R
visible
R
Check fluid
level,
security,
tightness
Motor.security,
con~ition
of blades .
Securlty
; check palnt marks;
clogging
indicator
not visible
Security,
pins in place and locked
8.4
99-38
';$
",,'
all
Condition
350 B2
"
and
.
.
Page 4
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
.EJ
.1.2
Check after
.
G)
,,[,
.loss
~
tit
STATION 1
checks:
Free from faults,
of slide.
cracks, unbonding,
350B2
8.4
99-38
Page 3
*RC*
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
.
.
.
[~~~
STATION
2
-Bidirectional
cross beam
.
Checkfor cracks on laminate
bearing upper face, on MGBpick-up
side.
Refer to NQIU.
to",
I'
"'"
CAUTION:THIS PAGE
MUSTONLYBE REMOVED
FROM
THEMANUAL
AFTER
INCORPORATION
OFMODIFICATION
072720.
350 B2
tit
~
8.4
99-38
Page 4
*RC*
-.
COMPLEMENTARYFLIGHTMANUAL
.I
RR7A I
STATION 2
.
.
.
After the check "universal joint assembly", add the following check:
-Firewall
Condition
35082
8.4
02-14
Page 4
*RR*
I
.C~PLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANU
-MAIN
ROTOR SHAFT
* Swashplate bearing:
check to
be performed within 5 min
after rotor stops "..""'."
.Scissors,
swivel
swashplates, rods,
bearings
.Swashplatelpitch
change rod
end-fitting
interface
,...".,."
* Star
* Star recesses
* Spherical thrust bearings
and frequency adapters
* 2-layer
frequency adapter.
.Self-lubricating
bearings
.Bushes in the ends of the
STARFLEX
hub anms
-Flared
Condition,
security;
pointer
play
housing
-Shock mount
magnetic
plug...
no friction
Security,
no craks,
corrosion nor
general condition
No delamination (splinters)
No cracks
No elastomer faults, unbonding,
scratches, blisters,
extrusion,
cracks
...Check for clearance between the
adapter and the metal shim.
Refer to NOTEB
No debris-nor-play.
Refer to ~
No space between the adhesive
bead and the bush.
Refer
to NOTE B.
No metal chips.
Refer
to ~~
Security
350 B2
8.4
9~
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANU~L
.
* MAIN ROTORBLADES
Attachment,
-Engine
air intake .."'.."
.Manufacturer's
air intake
-Engine
cowling
-Engine
mount
-Engine
and engine compartment
.Engine
and accessories
.Systems
,
.Controls
condition
of
polyurethane
protection
coating and of
the zone of tabs (visually
inspect for
debonding, blisters,
scratches,
cracks
dents and distortion).
On the stainless
steel leading edge
strip,
inspect for holes (erosion),
splaying
and dents.
Security,
blanking cover fitted
..Condition
of seal
Open:
condition
of locking systems
Condition,
security
General condition,
No leakage
cleanliness
Interference
.Transmission
-Freewheel
deck drain
-Gas generator
ARRIEL 1 D1 engine
modified TU202
-Tail
-Aft
general
not
pipe
baggage compartment
door.
Not plugged
Operate from the tail
rotor:
the free turbine
should be driven
when the tail
rotor turns clockwise.
When the tail
rotor turns counterclockwise,
the freewheel should desynchronize
(less important load).
Refer to NOTE B
When the ~less
than lS0.C,
turning
the compressor by hand,
confirm that the gas generator
rotates
freely
and that there is no
abnormal noise.
Security,
blanking cover fitted
Security,
closing
...
R
R
R
R
R
.
R
R
R
R
R
STATION3
-Horizontal
stabilizer,
tail
bumper
-TGB
-Tail
rotor guard (if
fin,
fitted)
".
Security,
Oil level,
S~curity,
condition
no leaks
condition
STATION 4
=~~
.Bellcrank
.Sealant
hinge
pin
bead
.Magnetic
-Horizontal
tail
Security
by applying
drive shaft
No Play
plug
stabilizer,
bumper
a load
Condition
No metal
chips.
Refer to ~
fin,
Security,
condition
350 B2
8.4
99-38
;-:;;'
~
on the
Page 6
COMPLEMENTARY FLIGHT
MANUAL
* TAIL
ROTOR BLADES...
Attachment,
* Tail
rotor
blade
.Laminated
.Blade
-THR
.Pitch
~
.Paint
spar
horn
condition
line
or
emergence
No play
security
control
on
and
in the
forI
debonding,
blisters,
scratches,
cracks,
dents
and distortion).
On the stainless
steel
leading
edge
strip,
inspect
for holes
(erosion).
splaying
and dents.
Check for
abnonnal
spar noise
when
Condition,
change
of
coating
inspect
the rotor
is
bent inwards
and
outwards
to fonn an arc.
Refer
to NOTE B
No bonding-separation,
deep crack
"'.'.".'.'.'.""
pitch
change
spacer/baffle
.Pitch
change
rod
bearing
,."..."."".",
.;
'"
half-bearing
control
No
misalignment.
swivel
"'.
Check,
(Refer
to~)
:
.the
absence
of play
(J) by twisting
the blades
back and forth.
low
amplitude
movements
(A) (Refer
to
Figure
3).
.the
condition
of the ball
joint.
by visual
inspection.
That
no Teflon
material
has
squeezed
out.
That
the ball
shows no signs
of burnishing
or scoring.
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
~
>
~
*
.Type
2 :
.Type
3 :
rubber
-rail
boom
flapping
bearing
Figure
(Flapping
hinge
bearing)
according
type:
.Type
1 : cups on either
of the pin
""".""".,.",
general
polyurethane
protection
trailing
edge
(visually
to
bearings
outside
side
Visual
'"
cone
play
No cracks,
fairing
,..",.".""
and
no metallic
particles
No play
extrusion.
bronze
chips
Security
350
B2
8.4
02-03
Page
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
STATION5
-Battery
-RH bagg~ge compartment door
-RH landlng
gear
.Shock
absorber
.Wear resistance
plate
-MGB cowling
-Transmission
deck
-MGB
.Magnetic
plug
-MGB suspension
bar
-Servo-controls,
hydraulic
system
-DUNLOP servo-controls.
Security
Secu~i~y,
condition,
locking
Condltlon
Condition,
no leaks
Condition
Open: condition
of locking
systems
Cleanliness
Leaktightness
No metal chips.
Refer to ~
Security
Security,
No cracks
seepage.
Oil level,
Security,
...Security,
Condition,
no leaks,
lines
on the body leading
to
-.t
R
R
-Engine
oil tank, system
security,
tightness
-Engine
oil cooler
no leaks
-Universal
joint
assembly..
pin fitted
-Engine
mount
security
-Engine
and engine compartment
.Engine
and accessories...
...General
condition,
cleanliness
.Systems
No leaks
.Controls
Interference
.Transmission
deck drain
Not plugged
* MAGNETIC PLUG
-ARRIEL
without
-Aft
reduction
gear magnetic
-Forward
reduction
plug (optional)
-Engine
..No
metal
reduction
plug.
Refer
to ~
Refer
to ~
R
R
R
gear magnetic
and MGBcowlings..
Closing,
locking
STATION6
-Sea~
-Cabln
Security,
pin ~n place
General cleanllness
N8
350 B2
8.4
99-38
-~---
Page 8
..COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
.I
RR7A I
STATION 5
After the check "universal joint assembly", add the following check:
-Firewall
.
.
""",
"
".'
Condition
35082
8.4
02-14
Page
*RR*
"""'."..""-".~"
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
STATION
5
, '
* MAGNETICPLUG:
-ARRIEL engine magnetic plugs without electrical
Replace the existing
"Aft
reduction
indication
text:
REFERTO NOTEA"
as follows:
"Aft reduction
hours
<)
.
~
CAUTION: THIS
PAGEMUST
ONLY
BETU
REMOVED
INCORPORATION
OF
MOD.
232. FROMTHE MANUALAFTER.
(:)
350 B2
8.4
99-38
Page 8
*RC*
---
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUA}."
[=~J
.,Q
STATION
5
-Bidirectional
cross beam
Refer to OOI.LC..
()
i
i
~
~
~
350 B2
8.4
99-38
Page 8
*RC*
.
.
.COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
on the
helicopter,
the daily
-windshield
-ferry
-blade
-sand
2.1
of each optional
and security
on the
wipers,
-fire
extinguisher,
-ski
installation,
-air
ambulance installation
-flares,
-cargo
swing,
(stretcher).
tank,
protection
filter.
The optional
below.
against
equipment
sand,
items
which require
item installed
hoist
the hoisting
blocks
to be performed
during
installation
operator.
-Perform
a hoist functional
check:
0.6 m (2 ft)
and then rewind it :
contact
functions
correctly.
-Check
specific
correctly.
the 30-hour
operating
limit.
.N
350B2
8.4
99-38
-:
-.-J
p.age
9
c
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
-Switch
on the electric
-Unwind
the cable
-Wind
an end-of-travel
microswitch
monitoring
the following:
hoist.
by approximately
the cable:
maintain
using
-Maintain
the
push-button:
.During
-the
-the
operation,
"Up" order
on the hoist
operator's
grip
and press
the test
-Operations
operations :
mechanism.
.Grease
the hoist brake assembly.
.Clean
then grease the cable winding
screw.
N8
350 82
8.4
99-38
",,",
~,
Page 10
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
2.2
Emeraency floatation
aear installation
flioht
the last
pins locked,
flioht
If the aircraft
has flown at low altitude over the sea, wash the
inflation
cylinders and the cradle assemblies.
2.3
Floatation
oear installation
Check before
-Visually
and free
-Check
the first
flioht
that
are clean
Check after
the last
flioht
-After
alighting
-After
I
!
Parkina
Crop sprayino
the floats
installation
Enaine fire
-Check that
2.6
extinauishino
2.7
staff
to
system
is correct.
Carao swina
-After
the last flight,
at the lock input.
and protect
lightly
-Check
the condition
350 B2
8.4
02-03
Page 11-
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
.3.1
General
General RecOlmlendations
For rational operation of the aircraft
recommendedto carry out the following
it is
8
ground
runs
be carried
out
every
two
hours
for
Lubricants
Below -2S .C, do not use AIR 3525 (0155) oil for transmission
assemblies without initial
preheating.
The other oils authorized in Section LIMITATIONSof the basic Flight
may be used down to -40 .C without preheating.
Manual
N8
350 B2
8.4
99-38
Page 12
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
3.4
Use of Batteries
for Startinq
and
80.C.
and the
Power plant
-Remove the air intake cover and the exhaust nozzle blank after removing
snow from the aircraft surface.
-Remove snow and ice accretion in the vicinity
of the air intake, on
either side of the screen and inside the engine air intake duct (remove
the air intake screen if necessary).
-It
.N
350 B2
8.4
99-38
Page 13
i-
c-"'
_oJ: _.COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
~
Tail
rotor
pitch
rods...).
rotate
the
tail
rotor
so
that
the
main
rotor
performs
turn
Structure
-Remove the cabin cover once the inspection is completed.
-Make sure that the windshield wiper has not remained stuck on the
canopy.
Fliaht
-Before
controls
-Enaine
controls
of the cabin.
-Operate
the controls
.
progressively,
and collective
the rotor
pitch control
brake
over their
of the cyclic
and
..
3S0 B2
8.4
99-38
Page 14
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
3.6
Check after
Last Flight
of the Day
The operations
described
in SECTIONS8.4.1 and 8.4.2 are to be completed
by the following
actions
-Inspection
of the engine magnetic plugs should be perfonned within
30
min after the rotor has stopped rotating,
in order to avoid seal
damaging.
-Care
must be taken not to leave doors open.
-Install
the air intake cover and exhaust nozzle blank.
-When the aircraft
is parked in an unsheltered
area it is recommended to
apply anti-icing
materials
and to carry out the aircraft
parking and
mooring.
CAUTION:
MATERIALS
COMPONENTS..
-USE RECOMMENDED
AND APPROVEDANTI-ICING
ONLY.
MATERIALS
.
.N
350 B2
8.4
99-38
P~ge 15
:...
";
>'l
---"'
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 9I
.OPERATIONAL
DATA
CONTENTS
9.1
RECOMMENDATIONS
FOR CARGOSLING OPERATIONS
9.2
EMERGENCYLOCATORTRANSMITTERS
9.3
SCHERMULYFLARES
9.4
AIR AMBULANCEINSTALLATION
.9.S
.
.
9.7
SEARCHLIGHT
9.8
9.9
SKI INSTALLATION
9.10
FREONAIR CONDITIONER
9.11
9.12
WANDELAND GOLTERMANN
HAILERS
350 B2
9.0.P6
02-03
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLI GHT MANUAL
SECTION 9.1
RECOMMENDATIONS;~
~
SLINGOPERATIONS
1
PERSONNEL TRAINING
Cargo sling
considerable
operations
experience
No pilot
may make solo cargo-carrying
accomplished
such operations
in the
informed
:
position
on the ground considering
the
direction
in which to move away;
hook-up
signals operation;
to be used or radio
instructions;
-protective
-the
n~ber
-the
manner
who already
flights
without
first
company of an instructor.
by pilots
having
by the pilot
proposed
equi~ent
: helmets.
9loves.
glasses
of round trips
between replenisi"lnents
of retrieving
slings
and nets.
(if
;
have
before
fl ight
each
path
applicable)
2 MANDATORY
PRE-OPERATIONAL
OiECKS
2.1
Helicopter
Condit10n
In addition
to the usual examination
of the helicopter.
must be carefully
examined and the mechanism checked
operation.
2.2
Condition
of Sling
The cables,
strops
and shackles
the maximun anticipated
load.
Preparation
of
Condition
2.5
Total
Weight
Any worn or
of carrying
three
times
Loads
of Loading
Remove or tie
thoroughly.
must be capable
the release
unit
correct
release
Equipment
The nets.
strops
and slings
must be examined
frayed components are to be discarded.
2.3
for
down all
and Unloading
that
of Helicopter
might
with
well
aware
of the
weight
of
the
is understood.
Areas
be displaced
by the
rotor
downwash.
Load
Define
maximum acceptable
load compatible
with terrain
configuration
and atmospheric
conditions.
Unless the platforms
are in clear
surroundings
and fairly
large.
consider
as maxim~
weight that which
can be held in hover O.G.E.
in calm air over the higher
of the two
platforms
(take-off
or landing).
35082
9.1
89-17
Page 1!
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
AIRBORNELOADS
Heavy loads, such as bags of cement or drLms of kerosen, which are carried
in a net, present no particular
problem.
Special precautions must be taken in the case of bulky loads, which have a
tendency to oscillate
and even to "float"
during transport on the sling.
PermeabilitY to air can have a stabilizing
effect on a bulky load:
for
example, a teleferic
car should be carried with both its doors open.
Never carry an airfoil
alone:
up into the tail rotor.
there
is a great risk
of the airfoil
flying
If several cables are used to sling the load, they must be long enough to
form an angle of less than 45' between cables at the point of suspension
under the helicopter,
experience shows that oscillation
of the load is
thus less likely to occur.
On the other hand, if the load is slung on a single sling cable: it is
preferable that a fairly
short cable be used as there is then less risk
of the load swinging, and it is easier to judge the height of the load
during approach.
For the retrieval
of crashed helicopters
a lifting
ring on the rotor shaft.
it
is generally
possible
to use
Airplanes are carried using straps passing under the fuselage or under
the wings. The cables must be attached in such a way that the airplane
is in a slightly
nose-down attitude when the helicopter
is in the hover.
4
IN-FLIGHT PRECAUTIONS
After hooking on the load the ground mechanic is to check the position of
the sling cables then move away. The pilot must then make sure that the
mechanic has moved clear and then confirm by signs that he may lift
off
the load.
Power must be applied slowly
itself
above the load.
A vertical take-off
ground or striking
Carefully
avoid flying
to swing,
to centre
reduce speed.
Approach must be made head into the wind with gradual reduction in
airspeed, and transition
into hover high enough above the ground to
eliminate the risk of dragging the load.
Set the load down, then reduce collective
pitch sufficiently
to slacken
the cables before opening the release unit hook; this also allows the
pilot to ensure that the load is deposited. If the cables are long enough,
move sideways a little
before opening the hook, to prevent the ring and
tackle from falling
onto the freight.
350
B2
9.1.
89-17
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
Even after the mechanic has signalled that the load is released. move
away as if it were not;
this is an advisable precaution against possible
misinterpretation
of signals.
.
.
.350
82
9.1
89-17
Page 3
COMPLEMENTARY FLIGHT
SECTION
1.
9.2
GENERAL
The JOLLIET
J.E.2
emergency
locator
simultaneously
on the international
243.0
MHz) to aid
helicopter
search
The unit
operates
automatically
operated
manually
by means of
or by means of a remote
control
MANUAL
transmits
radio
beacon
signals
distress
frequencies
(121.5
MHz and
and rescue
operations.
in the
switch
switch.
event
of crash
impact.
It
may be
on the transmitter
front
panel,
COMPONENT LOCATIONS
-A
locator
beacon is attached
to the structure
and is located
inside
the rear
baggage compartment.
-A
beacon
location
label
is attached
to the outside
of the aircraft.
-A
control
switch
is fitted
underneath
the instrument
panel
on the
pilot's
side.
-An
antenna
is located
on the tail
boom.
-A
label
fitted
close
to the switch
reads:
EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER
FOR AVIATION
EMERGENCY USE ONLY
3~
3.1
Pre-fliQht
On the
inspection
instrument
-Check
that
remote
control
switch
is
set
to
"AUTO".
On transmitter:
-For
old
.Check
.Press
generation
locator
beacons:
that
the switch
is set
to "AUTO"
in the "RESET" push-button.
-For
new generation
.Set
the switch
.Set
the switch
panel:
(NG) locator
beacons:
to "OFFjRST"
for 2 to 3 seconds
back to "AUTO".
35082
9.2
02-03
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
3.2
Pre-fliaht
.
.
checks
-Select
the international
distress frequency on the aircraft
VHF or UHF
system.
-Set switch beneath instrument panel to "MANU"for approximately one
R
second.
-The transmitter
output signal should be audible in the headphones.
-Set switch back to "AUTO".
R
3.3
Post-fliaht
check
4.1
transmitter
has not
OPERATING PROCEDURE
Automatic oDeration
The transmitter
is actuated automatically
the switch is set to "AUTO".
Imcact detector
reset:
in this
position
for
4.3
Manual oDeration
The unit
Portable
ODeration
The transmitter
350
82
99-48
9.2
.
Page 2
..COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 9.2
2.
1
ELT 96 EMERGENCY
LOCATORTRANSMITTER
GENERAL
The ELT 96 radio beacon is an emergency transmitter
which
the helicopter
in an emergency. It transmits
simultaneously
international
frequencies
(121,5 -243 -406
MHz).
is
used to locate
on the
The transmitter
starts
operating
automatically
in case of impact or in case
of cable breakage.
It may be switched on manually via the switch located
on the top face of
the transmitter
or via the remote control
switch located
under the
instrument
panel.
COMPONENTLOCATION
-A transmitter
attached to the structure
inside
the rear cargo hold.
-An
external
label indicating
transmitter
location.
-An AUTO -MANU control
switch located
under the instrument
panel on the
pilot's
side.
-An AUTO TEST/RESET pushbutton
located
next to the control
switch.
-A red XMIT ALERT indicator
light
located
on the instrument
panel on the
pilot's
side.
-An antenna on the LH side of the cabin roof.
-A label
fitted
close to the switch reads:
EMERGENCYLOCATORTRANSMITTER FOR AVIATION EMERGENCY
USE ONLY.
3~
3.1
Pre-fliQht
InsDection
CAUTION:
N
350 82
9.2
02-03
Page 3
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
..
3.2
Pre-fliaht
Checks
Post-fliaht
Check
operation
on the transmitter:
4 OPERATING
PROCEDURE
4.1
Automatic Ooeration
The transmitter
will begin operating automatically in case of impact if
the remote control switch is set to the "AUTO"position.
The red "XMIT ALERT" light comes on during transmitter operation.
ResettinQ the imoact detector
-Control
switch set to "AUT{)".
-Press the "AUTOTEST/RESET"pushbutton.
-The transmitter
should cease operating.
~
4.2
Manual Ooeration
The transmitter
will begin operating when the remote control switch is
set to "MANU".
The red "XMIT ALERT" light comes on during transmitter operation.
4.3
Portable Ooeration
The transmitter
N8
35082
9.2
02-03
Page 4
..
SECTION
3.
1
MANUAL
9.2
GENERAL
The NARCO ELT 910 emergency
locator
simultaneously
on the international
243.0
Mhz) to aid
helicopter
search
COMPLEMENTARY FLIGHT
transmits
radio
beacon
signals
distress
frequencies
(121.5
Mhz and
and rescue
operations.
COMPONENTS -LOCATION
-A
locator
beacon.
attached
rear
baggage
hold.
-An
external
identification
-A
control
unit,
located
on
-An
antenna,
located
on the
-A
label
fitted
close
to the
to
the
structure.
is
label
of the locator
the instrument
panel.
tail
boom.
switch
reads:
FOR AVIATION
positioned
inside
the
beacon.
3~
3.1
Pre-fliaht
On the
InsDection
instrument
-check
that
remote
On transmitter,
-ON-OFF-ARM
3.2
-Select
UHF
-Set
-The
-The
-Set
3.3
Pre-fliaht
panel:
control
check
is
set
After
landing,
accidentally
is
set
to
"ARM".
that:
to
"ARM".
Checks
the international
system.
control
unit
switch
indicator
light
on
transmitter
output
control
unit
switch
Post-fliaht
switch
distress
frequency
on the
to "ON" for
approximately
the remote
control
unit
signal
should
be audible
to "ARM".
aircraft
VHF or
two seconds.
lights
up.
in the headphones.
Check
ensure
that
been switched
the
on.
emergency
locator
transmitter
has
not
350 82
9.2
!)2-03
Page
--C~PLEMENTARY
FLIGHT
MANUAL -"""~
..
4
4.1
OPERATING PROCEDURE
Automatic
ODeration
The transmitter
is actuated automatically
4.2
ManualODeration
The unit maybe actuated manually by setting the switch to "ON".
4.3
Portable ODeration
The transmitter maybe used on the ground as follows:
.
N8
35082
9.2
02-03
Page6
I RR7B I
SECTION 9.2
1 GENERAL
The emergency locator transmits radio beacon signals simultaneously on
the international distress frequencies 121.5 MHz, 243.0 MHz and 406.025 Mhz
to aid helicopter search and rescue operations.
It can be actived manually or automatically in case of a crash.
2 DESCRIPTION
The KANNAD 406 AF beacons consist essentially of the following:
-A transmitter, located in the rear cargo compartment is fitted with "ARM-ON-OFF" switch,
-An antenna, located in the upper section of the intermediate structure,
-A remote control switch, located in instrument panel.
a
a
ON
ARMED
0:
>"
0:
lESTIRESET
DESCRIPTION
Amber light
FONCTION
-ON : transmission is effective
-Test mode:
.One long flash indicates
.
good test.
Buzzer
-Aural signal
3 position switch
350B2 9.2
.
02-20
Page 7
*RR*
..COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
I RR7B I
.3
OPERATION
3.1 Pre-Fliaht Check
-On transmitter:
.350B2
9.2
02-20
Page 8
'RR'
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION
9.3
SCHERMUL
Y FLARES
1
GENERAL
SCHERMULY
flares are used to Illunlnate
the ground during night operations.
Two flares are carried on a support on the port side of the fuselage.
.
i
LOCATIONOF SCHERMULY
FLARES
2
PILOT'S CONTROLS
Firing of the flares
canprises :
-a
-a
The firing
circuit
fuse panel.
3
is controlled
is protected
electrically.
The control
systen
on the contro 1
cyclic control grip.
by a fuse situated
on the control
console
OPERATING
INSTRUCTIONS
The maximun altitude
for firing
the flares is 1500 ft (500 m).
For maximun effectiveness,
the second flare should be fired at an altitude
of at least 800 ft (250 m).
It should be noted, however, that firing
the flares below 1200 ft (400 m)
may be dangerous if a fire hazard exists in the area to be Illuninated.
.350
82
9.3
89-17
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 9.4
.AIR
AMBULANCE
INSTALLATION
1
GENERAL
The air ambulance duty version is designed to carry one or two ~tretcher
patients accompanied by one or two medical assistants seated on the RH
rear seat.
&!
f'
R
.
.
DESCRIPTION
c
c
~
0;
.;"'
>'
350 B2
9.4
99-38
Page 1
'"j
J
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
::
c
UTILIZATION
Three configurations
-1
-2
are possible:
be time-saving to use
Whennot in service the stretchers are folded and stowed with their straps
in the baggage hold. The upper stretcher support frame folds down onto
the cabin floor.
Stretchers are installed
1. Lower stretcher
2. Upper stretcher
3.1
order:
(6)
(1).
3;1.1
in the following
Lower Stretcher
-Remove:
-Fold
3.1.2
Upper Stretcher
-Remove:
3.1.3
350 82
9.4
89-17
'"""
'
,~
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
3.2
Installing
the Stretchers
-Engage the rear handles of the stretchers in the brackets on the rear
bulkhead.
-Secure the retaining straps and hooks at the front and .Plp. pins
at the rear.
CAUTION: THE PATIENTSARE STRAPPED
TO THE STRETCHERS
AND MUSTBE
EMBARKED
FEET FORWARDS.
HEADTOWARDS
THETAIL.
.'.
.
.350
B2
9.4
89-17
Page 3
COMPLEMENTARYFLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION 9.5
SWIVELLI~~;;;;:LIGHT
1~
This swivelling
landing
light
that can be orientated
optional
equipment
item designed
to improve safety
phase and taxiing
operations.
This optional
equipment
the lower structure.
Its
lighting
power
is
is
installed
on the bottan,
forwa-d
A four-way
landing
light
assembly.
are
located
switch
is used to
retract
and extend
the
on the pilot's
is
confirmed
by
panel or on the
landin9
light.
are
protected
-a
2.5-Amp.
fuse
-a
2O-Amp. fuse
as follows:
on the R.H.
in the
side
electrical
panel
master
for
the
box for
control
the
circuits,
lighting
circuit.
B2
9.5
89-17
of
CIRCUIT PROTECTION
Circuits
.350
side
CONTROLS
An ON/OFF switch
is used to control
the lighting
which
the illumination
of an indicator
light
on the instrunent
Warning-Caution-Advisory
panel.
R.H.
450 Watts.
The controls
of the swivelling
collective
pitch
lever handgrip
in azimuth.
is an
during the approach
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
SECTION9.6
.RETRACTABLE-~:~
1
~ LANDING
LIGHT
GENERAL
This swivelling
and azimuth,
the approach
landing light
is an optional
equipment designed
phase and taxiin9
operations.
lighting
to
both in elevation
improve
safety
during
.I
g
,:
~
0
.,0;
,;
~
2 CONTROLS
Page 1
~
-~-
;;c.~
:;,"~
=",
R
R
R
R
R
R
3 CIRCUIT.PROTECTION
350 B2
R:
R
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION
9.7
SEARCHLIGHT
GENERAL
The LOCATOR searchlight
by a swivelling
light
rescue,
surveillance...).
installation
bean in order
is intended
to facilitate
to ill~inate
the
certain
missions
ground
(search,
COMPONENTLOCATIONS
This
-A
of
.a
.a
.a
.a
-A
installation
consists
mainly
of :
reflector
forward
L.H.
side
is hooked
onto
(4),
control
handgrip
(Detail
8) which, when not used,
support
located
between the two seats.
-An
amber light
near the control
handgrip
indicate
that the searchlight
is on.
support,
which
ill~inates
to
.
4
Detail
.350
Detail
82
9.7
89-17
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FlIGHT MANUAL
OPERATION
~~-~
Installation.
light.
A four-way button (7) is used to operate the reflector
the light bean in the desired direction.
~
for orientating
-after
to wait 3O.to 60
it on again.
.
.
.
350
B2
9.7.
89-17
Page 2
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION9.8
FUELTRONFUEL FLOWMETER
1~
The *FUELTRON#
fuel
fuel consunpt1on.
canputer
of fuel
stored
These values are computed from the momentary consumption which depends
on existing flIght parameters.
The computer is powered from the aircraft
supply via the battery contact
or the *RAZ-FUEL* pushbutton (if installed)
on the control pedestal. The
computer memory has its own battery
2
supply.
DESCRIPTION
0:
~
7
The indicator
on the instrument
panel consists
mainly of :
-A
digital
read-out (1) which indicates anyone of the following:
.the amount of fuel remaining
.the amount of fue 1 burned
.the flying time remaining (in hours and tenths of an hour).
-A digital
read-out (2) which indicates the manentary consl.lnption.
-A selector switch (3) with which one of the functions of (1) may be
chosen.
-A test selector (6) which:
.in *Test* position,
shows if 1 and 2 are functioning
correctly
.in *DIM* position.
reduces the brightness of items 1,2 and 7.
.350
82
9.8
89-17
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
-A
-A
used to store
pushbutton (8)
fuel data:
.
which indicates
the canputer
time
3 OPERATION
~~TRON~
measures the fuel flow rate but does not take in~ account
the fuel contained in the helicopter's
fuel tank. It is therefore
essential to program the amount of fuel on board at the beginning of the
flight.
The memory is accessible only when the white light is on. Thus, in order
to enter or add a fuel quantity or to enter a new value, the power must
be cut off using the RAZFUEL pushbutton (or by swItching off the battery
on units not equipped with this function).
NOTE: ~hen the engine is shut down but the booster pump is running, the
-unburned
regulator bleed fuel flow is approximately 45 litres/hour
(12 U.S. Gal./hour).
This flow dIsappears when the engIne is
started.
A) Test
Displays
8) EnterIng
a Fuel QuantIty
-3
..6
-4
-5
-5
-9
-7
-6
-3
8's.
In
In
In
in
ADDposItIon
8RIGHTor DIM positIon as required
ADDposItIon
STOREposition:
.one pulse for units
.two pulses for tens
.three
pulses for hundreds
.four pulses for thousands.
in SET position to set digits
on
on
in TEST position and 8 held depressed until light 9 goes out and
lIght 7 dIms
in FUEL REMAININGposition.
Read fuel quantity entered.
350
82
9.8.
89-17
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARYFLIGHT MANUAL
C) Recalling
-3
-5
-9
-7
-4
-8
-3
Paral!1eters
before
Switching
in ADO position
in BRIGHT or OIM position
on
on
in NONE position
held depressed until
light
in FUEL REMAINING position.
D) Adding
Off
Battery
as required
9 goes out
Read fuel
and light
quantity
7 dims
stored
in memory.
Fuel
-Switch
-3
in
-5
in
-4
in
-5
in
-5
-9on
-7
on
-8
held depressed until
light
-3
in FUa. REMAINING position.
added fuel).
E) Entering
a Preset
Refuelling
9 goes out.
Light
Read sun of fuel
7 dims
(remaining
or battery)
fuel
plus
Quantity
.This function
is available
when the required
fuel
quantity
has been
stored
in memory as per procedure
set forth
in paragraph 8.
-9
on
-4
in FUU. position
-5
in BRIGHT or DIM position
-5
in middle posItion
-8
held depressed until
light
9 goes out.
Light
7 dims.
F) In-Flight
Use
-3
-3
-3
in BURNEDposition.
quantity
of fuel burned since
in FUa. REMAINING position.
quantity
entered
less
in TIME REMAINING position
FUEL REMAINING
FUEL FLOW
-FUEL FLOW displayed
by lower readout.
.350
memory entry
quantity
burned
B2
9.8
89-17
Page 3
.COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
SECTION g.g
.SKI
INSTALLATION
l~
The ski installation
is designed for takeoff
snow-covered ground.
or landing on normal or
DESCRIPTION
The skis are secured to the pads via clamps. SEFAskis have a glassfiber/resin
laminate structure and SURFAIRskis have a metal structure.
The rear spatula of the ski is reinforced with one or two struts.
SURFAIRskis enable 4 pairs of Alpine skis to be carried.
R
R
R
R
SEFA
g
0
.;
~
>
SURFAIR
.~
~
"c
g
,;
~
OPERATION
Special attention
.landing
in deepsnow.
3SD82
9.9
99-38
~~
Page 1
..,
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION9.10
.FREON
AIR CONDITIONER
.1~
The air conditioning
temperature
within
system is designed
the cabin.
to maintain
a comfortable
SYSTEMCONTROLSAND INDICATORS
-Available
to the pilot
0;
.;
g
g
~
ITEM
4
-Available
DESCRIPTION
Rocker switch:
.OFF
.FAN
.A/C
FUNCTION
neutral
engaged
engaged
Rocker switch:
.lOW neutral
.HI
engaged
.MED engaged
Protection
fuses for condenser
and fan blowers
Ventilation
to
and
outlets
the passenqers
Six swivelling
and adjustable
ventilation
rate.
I
outlets
used to
obtain
the desired
R
350 B2
9.10
99-38
Page 1
~,
COMPLEMENTARY FLIGHT
MANU~l
UTILIZATION
System operation
-Set
-Select
ventilation
System shutdown
-Set rocker switch 1 to "OFF" (neutral position).
-Should the system fail,
set rocker switch 1 to "OFF".
4
PERFORMANCE
DATA
The impact of the air conditioning system on the perfonnance data given in
the Basic Flight Manual is negligible.
350 B2
9.10
99-38
:.
.;--
.
.
Page 2
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
UTILIZATION
;;:-~ation
-Set
-Select
ventilation
System
shutdown
-Set
-Should
4
set rocker
posltiQ1)
switch 1 to OFF.
PERFORMANCE
OATA
The impact of the air condItioning system on the performance da~
in the basic Flight Manual 1s negligible.
given
.
.350
82
9.10
89-17
Page 3
.I
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
f!
SECTION9.11
.FAURE
HERMAN
FUELFLOWMETER
1~
the quantity
of fuel
contained
account
of fuel
in the
the
stored
in its
ENG.
GTM
OPERATINGPRINCIPLE
ill
1 Temperature signal
2 Temperature probe
3 Turbine
4 Permanent magnet
5 Flowrate signal
6 Digital
indicator
.5
.
.Figure
DEBIT FLOW
[:~:I]I[~~]]a REST.6
l___~-=-1~~~~~~~Jmn
-T
REH.O x 10
LIMIT
e-Q+~
Kg 0
TEST
PRESET IIDIM~
1 -Functional
diagram
35082
9. 11
99-38
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY.cflIGHT
MANUAL
3 DESCRIPTION
.
3.1
Indicator
I
Front
face
Back
face
3
LBS
"1
UNITE
UNIT
ILICIPTERE
-9
.;
~
c
.;
.GAL
14'.GAL
6
ITEM
DESCRIPTION
FUNCTION
LH side digital
displays
RH side digital
displays
remaining,
Removable units
label
"TEST" "DIM"
push-button
"PRESET"switch
-Displays
the amount of fuel when switch (7) is in
bottom released position.
Reading in tens of units is displayed in (2)
-Switch position:
.Centre;
.I
..II
rest
35082
9. 11
99-38
Page 3
,.
~
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANU~
t;
~
ITEM
DESCRIPTION
FUNCTION
/--~
,
6
.T.LIMIT"
indicator
amber
light
Three-position
function switch
.UNIT" switch
"HELICOPTERS
lYPE" switch
"'-;C-
R
R
R ~
4 OPERATION
NOTE: The standard aircraft
fuel quantity gauge readings must take
precedence over the fuel flowmeter computer.
4.1
In fliqht
-Flow (debit) read on display unit (2).
-Remaining time (T) read on the LH display and remaining quantity
(REM.Q) read on the RH display (2).
4.2
On the qround
This operation is carried out when fuel is added in the tank.
-Trip
selector switch (7) to down position (position protected by a
locking system).
The amount of fuel
remaining is indicated
on the RHdisplay.
?
,;;c.!
1.
3[
350 82
9. 11
99-38
99:-38
Page 4
Page 2 ';;~i:;;.J~
:'j':;:;"r1~-
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
and
.I
.
N
.35082
9.11
92-12
Page 5
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SEmON 9.12
WANDELAND GOlTERMANN
HAILERS
1~
QE-1.lli
either
The installation
of this optional system does not affect the approved
sections of the Flight Manual. The effect on the additional
performance
data is negligible.
2 DESCRIPTION
~~:
mainly
consists
of :
-two amplifiers
located in the lH side baggage hold,
-four
hailers
fixed two by two on the rear cross beam of the landing gear,
-one microphone located on the RH side of the copilot's
seat and fitted
with two push-buttons:
a black one for the mike function and a red one
for the siren.
The system is
a fuse.
and is protected
by
.
.
.350
82
9. 12
93-05
Page 1
..COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
SECTION 9.27
MINI-HUMS SYTEM
1
GENEREAL
DESCRIPTION
2.1
General
layout
The data are transferred from the airborne unit to the ground station
via a removable magnetic card of the PCMCIAtype.
2.2
Control
and display
unit
-/~\~
.e
~~@~~/STB3 @]~ e
DDDDDDDDDDDD DDDDDDD
DDDDDDDDDDDDDDDDDDDD
~~~~[]
~
~
~~~~~~
DATA
AKE
/1
5
35082
9.27
99-48
--
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
ITEM
1
DESCRIPTION
Annunciator
FUNCTION
lights
-ENG 1
-EXCD
-assurance
-ENG 2
-STB 1, STB 2 & STB 3
-PC
-DCU
Display panel
Alpha-numeric display
monitoring data.
Vernier
Push-button
knob
-PAC 1
-SUMM
-CFRM
-EVNT
-PAC 2
-GMT
-EXCD
-TEST
-PARM
-SLING
6
Locking knobs
Used to validate
modified.
350 B2
9.27
99-48
Page 2
..COMPLEMENTARY
2.3
FLIGHT MANUAL
PCMCIAcard readers
These
front
~:
card
face
readers
of the
can be accessed
airborne
unit.
.
.
unlocking
and
folding
down
the
after
..
..
~
on
on
..
~
>
ITEM
DESCRIPTION
FUNCTION
Loading orifices
Used to insert
two readers.
Push-button
Used to eject
reader.
Indicator
light
the card is
35082
9.27
99-48
Page 3
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
3 OPERATION
~~~up,
theairborne
unitis energized
andtheself-testsequence
is .
initiated.
During this test, if no fault is detected on the computer or
on the PCMCIAcard, the PC and DCUlights must be out and the data related
to the aircraft
are displayed (refer to the approved section of the Flight
Manual).
3.1
"TEST" function:
test
and briahtness
adiustment
a computer test
the test function.
"GMT" function:
power-up screen,
i}
35082
9.27
99-48
Page 4
.
.
..COMPLEMENTARY
3.3
FLIGHTMANUAL
automatic
3.4
"PARM"function:
display
"EVNT" function:
event markina
.The
time,
.The airspeed,
.The OAT
.The altitude.
350 B2
9.27
99-48
Page 5
:)
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
3.6
"SLING" fuction
"EXCD" function:
When a limit
illuminates.
If the limit
ciator light
monitorina
of the limit
exceedance is detected,
exceedances
the EXCDannunciator
light
"SUMM"function:
of take-offs,
duration,
.Engine cycles,
.Number of alarms,
.Number of exceedances
i)
35082
9.27
99-48
Page 6
..COMPLEMENTARY
3.9
.
"CFRM"function:
of the session.
FLIGHTMANUAL
confirmation
This function can only be used on the ground, with the engine and the
rotor stopped. A press on the CFRMpush-button activates the function
penmitting the data recorded during the session to be validated.
NOTE: All the data are validated by default. An information is not
erased when it is not validated.
It is simply marked as
"REJECTED".
~i
.
.
350B2
9.27
99-48
Page 7
.
.
"
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION10
ADDITIONAL PERFORMANCE
DATA
CONTENTS
10.1
RESERVED
10.2
BASIC PERFORMANCE
DATA
10.3
10.4
PERFORMANCE
DATAWITH;
R
R
.
.N
350 B2
10.0.P6
99-38
Page 1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION10.1
CONVERSION
TABLES
km/h -kt
km/h
km/h -kt
-kt
km/h
1.852
3.704
5.556
7.408
9.260
11.112
12.964
14.816
16.668
18.520
20.372
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
22.224
24.076
25.928
27.780
29.632
31.484
33.336
35.188
37.040
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
38.892
40.744
42.596
44.448
46.300
48.152
50.004
51.856
53.708
55.560
57.412
0.540
1.080
1.620
2.160
2.700
3.239
3.779
4.319
4.859
5.399
5.939
-kt
94.452
~6.304
98.156
100.008
101.860
103.712
105.564
107.416
109.268
111.120
112.972
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
27.535
28.075
28.615
29.155
29.695
30.234
30.774
31.314
31.854
32.394
32.934
6.479
7.019
7.559
8.099
8.638
9.178
9.718
10.258
10.798
114.824
116.676
118.528
120.380
122.232
124.084
125.936
127.788
129.640
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
33.474
34.014
34.554
35.094
35.633
36.173
36.713
37.253
37.793
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
11.338
11.878
12.418
12.958
13.498
14.037
14.577
15.117
15.657
16.197
16.737
131.492
133.344
135.196
137.048
138.900
140.752
142.604
144.456
146.308
148.160
150.012
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
38.333
38.873
39.413
39.953
40.493
41.032
41.572
42.112
42.652
43.192
43.732I
59.264
32
17.277
151.864
82
44.272
61.116
62.968
64.820
66.672
68.524
70.376
72.228
74.080
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
17.817
18.357
18.897
19.436
-19.976
.20.516
21.056
21.596
153.716
155.568
157.420
159.272
161.124
162.976
164.828
166.680
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
44.812
45.352
45.892
46.431
46.971
47.511
48.051
48.591
75.932
77.784
79.636
81.488
83.340
85.192
87.044
88.896
90.748
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
22.136
22.676
23.216
23.756
24.296
24.835
25.375
25.915
26.455
168.532
170.384
172.236
174.088
175.940
177.792
179.644
181.496
183.348
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
49.131
49.671
50.211
50.751
51.291
51.830
52.370
52.910
53.450
92.600
50
26.995
185.200
100
53.990
.35082
10.1
92-12
Page1
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
mm
ft
-ft
m-
ft
---ft
0.305
0.610
0.914
1.219
1.524
1.829
2.134
2.438
2.743
3.048
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
3.281
6.562
9.843
13.124
16.405
19.685
22.966
26.247
29.528
32.809
15.545
15.850
16.154
16.459
16.764
17.069
17.374
17.678
17.983
18.288
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
167.326
170.607
173.888
177.169
180.450
183.730
187.0ll
190.292
193.573
196.854
3.353
3.658
3.962
II
12
13
36.090
39.371
42.652
18.593
18.898
19.202
61
62
63
200.135
203.416
206.697
4.267
4.572
4.877
5.182
5.486
5.791
6.096
6.401
6.706
7.010
7.315
7.620
7.925
8.230
8.534
8.839
9.144
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
45.933
49.214
52.494
55.775
59.056
62.337
65.618
68.899
72.180
75.461
78.742
82.023
85.303
88.584
91.865
95.146
98.427
19.507
19.812
20.ll7
20.422
20.726
21.031
21.336
21.641
21.946
22.250
22.555
22.860
23.165
23.470
23.774
24.079
24.384
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
209.978
213.259
216.539
219.820
223.101
226.382
229.663
232.944
236.225
239.506
242.787
246.068
249.348
252.629
255.910
259.191
262.472
31
32
101.708
104.989
24.689
24.994
81
82
265.753
269.034
33
34
35
108.270
lll.551
ll4.832
25.298
25.603
25.908
83
84
85
272.315
275.596
278.877
9.449
9.754
10.058
10.363
10.668
10.973
36
ll8.ll2
26.213
86
282.157
11.278
11.582
11.887
12.192
37
38
39
40
121.393
124.674
127.955
131.236
26.518
26.822
27.127
27.432
87
88
89
90
285.438
288.719
292.000
295.281
12.497
12.802
13.106
13.4ll
13.716
14.021
14.326
14.630
14.935
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
134.517
137.798
141.079
144.360
147.641
150.921
154.202
157.483
160.764
27.737
28.042
28.346
28.651
28.956
29.261
29.566
29.870
30.175
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
298.562
301.843
305.124
308.405
3ll.686
314.966
318.247
321.528
324.809
15.240
50
164.045
30.480
100
328.090
.
.
N
3508210.1
.
92-12
Page2
.
.
,; ,
;:
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
kg -lb
ko
kg
-lb
kg
lb
-lb
0.454
0.907
1.361
1.814
2.268
2.722
3.175
3.629
4.082
4.536
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2.205
4.409
6.614
8.818
11.023
13.228
15.432
17.637
19.842
22.046
23.134
23.587
24.041
24.494
24.948
25.402
25.855
26.309
26.762
27.216
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
112.436
114.640
116.845
119.049
121.254
123.459
125.663
127.868
130.073
132.277
4.990
5.443
5.897
11
12
13
24.251
26.455
28.660
27.670
28.123
28.577
61
62
63
134.482
136.686
138.891
6.350
6.804
7.258
7.711
8.165
8.618
9.072
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
30.865
33.069
35.274
37.479
39.683
41.888
44.092
29.030
29.484
29.938
30.391
30.845
31.298
31.752
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
141.096
143.300
145.505
147.710
149.914
152.119
154.323
9.526
9.979
21
22
46.297
48.502
32.206
32.659
71
72
156.528
158.733
10.433
10.886
11.340
11.794
12.247
12.701
13.154
13.608
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
50.706
52.911
55.116
57.320
59.525
61.729
63.934
66.139
33.113
33.566
34.020
34.474
34.927
35.381
35.834
36.288
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
160.937
163.142
165.347
167.551
169.756
171.960
174.165
176.370
14.062
14.515
14.969
15.422
31
32
33
34
68.343
70.548
72.752
74.957
36.742
37.195
37.649
38.102
81
82
83
84
178.574
180.779
182.983
185.188
15.876
16.330
16.783
17.237
17.690
18.144
35
36
37
38
39
40
77.162
79.366
81.571
83.776
85.980
88.185
38.556
39.010
39.463
39.917
40.370
40.824
85
86
87
88
89
90
187.393
189.597
191.802
194.007
196.211
198.416
18.598
19.051
19.505
19.958
20.412
20.866
21.319
21.773
22.226
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
90.389
92.594
94.799
97.003
99.208
101.413
103.617
105.822
108.026
41.278
41.731
42.185
42.638
43.092
43.546
43.999
44.453
44.906
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
200.620
202.825
205.030
207.234
209.439
211.644
213.848
216.053
218.257
22.680
50
110.231
45.360
100
220.462 J
.35082
10.1
92-12
Page3
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
Litre
Litre
-US
--US
aal
gal
Litre
-US
Litre
-US
al
gal
3.785
7.571
11.356
15.142
18.927
22.712
26.498
30.283
34.069
37.854
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
0.264
0.528
0.793
1.057
1.321
1.585
1.849
2.113
2.378
2.642
193.055
196.841
200.626
204.412
208.197
211.982
215.768
219.553
223.339
227.124
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
13.473
13.737
14.001
14.265
14.529
14.794
15.058
15.322
15.586
15.850
41.639
45.425
49.210
11
12
13
2.906
3.170
3.434
230.909
234.695
238.480
61
62
63
16.114
16.379
16.643
52.996
56.781
60.566
64.352
68.137
71.923
75.708
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
3.698
3.963
4.227
4.491
4.755
5.019
5.283
242.266
246.051
249.836
253.622
257.407
261.193
264.978
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
16.907
17.171
17.435
17.699
17.964
18.228
18.492
79.493
83.279
87.064
90.850
94.635
98.420
102.206
105.991
109.777
113.562
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
5.548
5.812
6.076
6.340
6.604
6.868
7.133
7.397
7.661
7.925
268.763
272.549
276.334
280.120
283.905
287.690
291.476
295.261
299.047
302.832
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
18.756
19.020
19.284
19.549
19.813
20.077
20.341
20.605
20.869
21.134
117.347
121.133
124.918
128.704
132.489
31
32
33
34
35
8.189
8.453
8.718
8.982
9.246
306.617
310.403
314.188
317.974
321.759
81
82
83
84
85
21.398
21.662
21.926
22.190
22.454
136.274
36
325.544
86
22.719
140.060
143.845
147.631
151.416
37
38
39
40
9.774
10.038
10.303
10.567
9.510
329.330
333.115
336.901
340.686
87
88
89
90
22.983
23.247
23.511
23.775
155.201
158.987
162.772
166.558
170.343
174.128
177.914
181.699
185.485
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
10.831
11.095
11.359
11.623
11.888
12.152
12.416
12.680
12.944
344.471
348.257
352.042
355.828
359.613
363.398
367.184
370.969
374.755
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
24.039
24.304
24.568
24.832
25.096
25.360
25.624
25.889
26.153
189.270
50
13.209
378.540
100
26.417
.
N
3508210.1
.
92-12
Page4
: ! t:';
COMPLEMENTARYFLIGHT MANUAL
Litre
Litre
-UK--9-al
4.546
9.092
13.638
18.184
'
.350
gal
Litre
Litre
-UK~al
-UK
gal
1
2
0.220
0.440
231.846
236.392
51
52
11.218
11.438
3
4
0.660
0.880
240.938
245.484
53
54
11.658
11.878
22.730
250.030
55
12.098
1.320
254.576
56
12.318
31.822
1.540
259.122
57
12.538
36.368
1.760
263.668
58
12.758
40.914
45.460
9
10
1.980
2.200
268.214
272.760
59
60
12.978
13.198
50.006
54.552
59.098
11
12
13
2.420
2.640
2.860
277.306
281.852
286.398
61
62
63
13.418
13.638
13.858
63.644
14
3.080
290.944
64.
14.078
68.190
15
3.300
295.490
65
14.298
72.736
16
3.520
300.036
66
14.518
77.282.17
81.828
86.374
18
19
3.739
3.959
4.179
304.582
309.128
313.674
67
68
69
14.738
14.958
15.178
90.920
20
4.399
318.220
70
15.398
27.276
-UK
1.100
95.466
21
4.619
322.766
71
15.618
100.012
22
4.839
327.312
72
15.838
104.558
23
5.059
331.858
73
16.058
109.104
24
5.279
336.404
74
16.278
113.650
25
5.499
340.950
75
16.498
118.196
122.742
26
27
5.719
5.939
345.496
350.042
76
77
16.718
16.938
127.288
131.834
28
29
6.159
6.379
354.588
359.134
78
79
17.158
17.378
136.380
30
6.599
363.680
80
17.598
140.926
145.472
150.018
154.564
159.110
31
32
33
34
35
6.819
7.039
7.259
7.479
7.699
368.226
372.772
377.318
381.864
386.410
81
82
83
84
85
17.818
18.038
18.258
18.477
18.697
163.656
36
7.919
390.956
86
18.917
168.202
172.748
37
38
8.139
8.359
395.502
400.048
87
88
19.137
19.357
177.294
39
8.579
404.594
89
19.577
181.840
40
8.799
409.140
90
19.797
186.386
190.932
195.478
200.024
204.570
209.116
213.662
218.208
222.754
227.300
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
9.019
9.239
9.459
9.679
9.899
10.119
10.339
10.559
10.779
10.999
413.686
418.232
422.778
427.324
431.870
436.416
440.962
445.508
450.054
454.600
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
20.017
20.237
20.457
20.677
20.897
21.117
21.337
21.557
21.777
21.997
B2
10.1
92-12
Page 5
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
nm -inch
inch
nm
nm
nm
--inch
--inch
25.4
50.8
76.2
101.6
127.0
152.4
177.8
203.2
228.6
254.0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
0.039
0.079
0.118
0.157
0.197
0.236
0.276
0.315
0.354
0.394
1295.4
1320.8
1346.2
1371.6
1397.0
1422.4
1447.8
1473.2
1498.6
1524.0
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
2.008
2.047
2.087
2.126
2.165
2.205
2.244
2.283
2.323
2.362
279.4
304.8
330.2
U
12
13
0.433
0.472
0.512
1549.4
1574.8
1 600.2
61
62
63
2.402
2.441
2.480
355.6
14
0.551
1625.6
64
2.520
381.0
406.4
431.8
457.2
482.6
508.0
15
16
17
18
19
20
0.591
0.630
0.669
0.709
0.748
0.787
1651.0
1676.4
1701.8
1727.2
1 752.6
1778.0
65
66
67
68
~9
70
2.559
2.598
2.638
2.677
2.717
2.756
533.4
558.8
584.2
609.6
635.0
660.4
685.8
711.2
736.6
762.0
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
0.827
0.866
0.906
0.945
0.984
1.024
1.063
1.102
1.142
1.181
1803.4
1828.8
1854.2
1879.6
1905.0
1930.4
1955.8
1981.2
2006.6
2032.0
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
2.795
2.835
2.874
2.913
2.953
2,992
3.031
3.071
3.110
3.150
787.4
812.8
838.2
863.6
889.0
31
32
33
34
35
1.220
1.260
1.299
1.339
1.378
2057.4
2082.8
2108.2
2133.6
2159.0
81
82
83
84
85
3.189
3.228
3.268
3.307
3.346
914.4
939.8
965.2
990.6
1016.0
36
37
38
39
40
1.417
1.457
1.496
1.535
1.575
2184.4
2209.8
2235.2
2260.6
2286.0
86
87
88
89
90
3.386
3.425
3.465
3.504
3.543
1041.4
1066.8
1092.2
1117.6
1143.0
1168.4
1193.8
1219.2
1244.6
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
1.614
1.654
1.693
1.732
1.772
1.811
1.850
1.890
1.929
23U.4
2 336.8
2 362.2
2 387.6
2413.0
2438.4
2463.8
2489.2
2 514.6
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
3.583
3.622
3.661
3.701
3.740
3.780
3.819
3.858
3.898
1270.0
50
1.969
100
3.937
L2540.0
.
N
35082 10.1
.
92-12
Page6
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
bar -psi
bar
bar -psi
-Dsi
bar
-Dsi
0.069
0.138
0.207
0.276
0.345
0.414
0.483
0.552
0.620
0.689
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
14.506
29.011
43.517
58.023
72.529
87.034
101.540
116.046
130.551
145.057
3.516
3.585
3.654
3.723
3.792
3.861
3.929
3.998
4.067
4.136
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
739.791
754.296
768.802
783.308
797.814
812.319
826.825
841.331
855.836
870.342
0.758
0.827
0.896
U
12
13
159.563
174.068
188.574
4.205
4.274
4.343
61
62
63
884.848
899.353
913.859
0.965
1.034
1.103
1.172
1.241
1.310
1.379
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
203.080
217.586
232.091
246.597
261.103
275.608
290.U4
4.412
4.481
4.550
4.619
4.688
4.757
4.826
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
928.365
942.871
957.376
971.882
986.388
1.000.893
1.015.399
1.448
1.517
1.586
1.655
1.723
1.792
1.861
1.930
1.999
2.068
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
304.620
319.125
333.631
348.137
362.643
377.148
391.654
406.160
420.665
435.171
4.895
4.964
5.032
5.101
5.170
5.239
5.308
5.377
5.446
5.515
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
1.029.905
1.044.410
1.058.916
1.073.422
1.087.928
1.102.433
1.U6.939
1.131.445
1.145.950
1.160.456
2.137
2.206
2.275
2.344
31
32
33
34
449.677
464.182
478.688
493.194
5.584
5.653
5.722
5.791
81
82
83
84
1.174.962
1.189.467
1.203.973
1.218.479
2.413
35
507.700
5.860
85
1.232.985
2.482
2.551
2.620
2.689
2.758
36
37
38
39
40
522.205
536.7U
551.217
565.722
580.228
5.929
5.998
6.067
6.135
6.204
86
87
88
89
90
1.247.490
1.261.996
1.276.502
1.291.007
1.305.513
2.826
2.895
2.964
3.033
3.102
3.171
3.240
3.309
3.378
3.447
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
594.734
609.239
623.745
638.251
652.757
667.262
681.768
696.274
710.779
725.285
6.273
6.342
6.4U
6.480
6.549
6.618
6.687
6.756
6.825
6.894
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
1.320.019
1.334.524
1.349.030
1.363.536
1.378.042
1.392.547
1.407.053
1.421.559
1.436.064
1.450.570
.35082
10.1
92-12
Page 7
I
COMPLEMENTARYFLIGHT MANUAL
SECTION
10.2
BASIC PERFORMANCE
DATA
Figure
-DETERMINING
-TAS/CAS
IN FAST CRUISE
C'
-FUEL
CONSUMPTION -RANGE
-FUEL
-RANGE
IN FAST CRUISE
4
5
IN RECOMMENDEDCRUISE
-FUEL CONSUMPTION
-ENDURANCE
IN CRUISEAT MINIMUM
HOURLY FUEL CONSUMPTION
-DISTANCE
TO CLEAR A 50-FT
OBSTACLE ON TAKE-OFF
-DISTANCE
;Zr~:;;;:c
N
18
350B2
10.2
92-12
Page 1
".
,.Tgure
;lAS/CAS
~~~U~~E
IN
CONDITION
FAST CRUISE
-Stabilized
level
flight
.350
B2
10.2
92-12
--
Page 3
33 .
COMPLEMENTARYFLIGHT MANUAL
>.
,.
,.
: .;
L
i!
.,
~
.0
..!
i
i;
-40
-30-20
-10
TEIf' .EXT.
10
20
I O.A. T.
30
40
50
80
(.C>
I~
2000
MASSE CMRIIEE
Figure
NOTE:
weight
limitations
with
are given in section
2
internal
load
I Cl$llECTED
\EICJiT
CORRECTEDWEIGHT TO
DETERMINE SPEEDS
(on facing
page)
N
350
82
10.2
.
92-12
Page 2
.
.
-..COMI'LtMtNTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
s..
....
~'
..0 -~
-20'-10 0 10 20 ~ 40 50 eo
TEW,EXT./O.A.T.
loCI
1.
I
I
100
200
,
,
110"
220
~lbII\l2&O
I
I
"
I
I
120 TM 1'30IKtJ 140
~'
,
"
.I
1S!
'\
~~
200
.I_"'
I I I , I , , I I I I I I I I I I I
80
100 ~
120 CAS 140 IKtJ
Figure 2
;lAS/CAS
~~~U~~E
IN
CONDITION
FAST CRUISE
-Stabilized
level
flight
.350
82
1 0.2
92-12
Page 3
COMPtEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
31
33
as .
-
..
.'
---ii
eO;:
~
l-
~
g
i;
-10
10 20 ~
40 50 60 1500
2000
MA& ~IE
2500
-3500
I ~CTiD
1100
Figure 1
NOTE:
weight limitations
with
are given in section 2
internal
load
CORREmD WEIGHTTO
DETERMINESPEEDS
(on facing page)
N
35082
E ~~
1 0.2
92-12
Page 4
10.2
92-12
Page 2
"' "
"c
C~NTARY
.11
FLIGHT MANUAL
00:
...
"\ ...'"
..
""
,'1;
.'
1
-40-30-20-10
0 10 20 30 40 eo eo 1~0
TEMP.EXT./.O.A.T.
('C)
200
__L _'_'l
TAS go Vp100
2eo
r
0
kkOl/h)
,
,i,
,
I
I
110
1120
130(k~)
~.,~-
"\
"
...
O' .+'\0..
..~
.'I'
t~
~~
..'I'~
.~
.I.~~
~.,_.~. "1:
'"
eo
I , I I I I I I , I I I I I I I
80
100
120(k~)140
VC /
CAS
Figure
CONDITIONS
-Stabilized
-TAS
level
flight
to
RECOMMENDED
CRUISE DATA
N
.350
82
1 0.2
92-12
Page 5
--""
"-
(kg/hI)
.
r
+"
300
100
250
110
...90200
.
.
.
-40 -~
-20 -10 0
..70
10 20 ~
40 50 50
TEIfI.EXT/O...T.IOtl
0.5
0.6:
0.7
0.8
0.91kQ1k81I
"'1,1""'11""'"
1.0
li2
1.4
1.6
l.8 (k~*)
, , , I I C, , , I , , , , I , , , , I
2.5:
3
3.5 11b1181
4
~./VIT.
CQG./~ED
{tal 1000
:
(kil
400 I
aM>i
IX)
i
~ 100
i
~ 0 0
Figure 4
CONDITION
-Stabilized
flight
N
3S0
82
10.2
.
92-12
Page 6I
COMprEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
Ik;/kal
o.g
IkgII8)
(ID/ItI)
I.
3.5
0.8
Q
...3
..~~
I.
~ 0.7
..."
G
~
'" 0.6
I.
2.S
--
.I.
g O.S
.2
'"
0.8
o.
_30
.20
-..
';10
...
~
... 0
~-10
-20
-30
:=
i 4
i:I
0 i
.;
~
0
70
S?
.
~
..,.
go
I
200
100
'
110
.,
120
.I
~.
'
.,
250
H 1 lQft.y ~.
130
,
140
I
ISO
.,
300
160Ikg/h)
,
350 IID/hl
Figure 5
CONDITION
-Stabilized
level
FUEL CONSUMPTIONENDURANCE
IN
RECOMMENDED
CRUISE
flight
.350
82
1 0.2
92-12
Page 7
COMPtEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
f- 2200
(Kg)
~J:
-(lb)
.4500
:;:
~ 2000 """
.~
~
" 1800 -.:;:r-~
...~...
0
(I)
4000
,-;!
<1
~
..."
1600
'
3500
...
1400
'\
2000
!\
1\
4000
!j;
"
6000
,..
\ .\ \X~
'\
\
\\
;\
\..
12000
1\
.I
\ \
\\!
.\
~
L\J\N
\,
\ ,
..\.\
,
'\
..\
1000
\,
'"
.\
10000
(M]
.,
.\
8000
\
1\
Cl
(ftl
\,
.\;~
1\
I
ISA-20
MASSE/wEIGHT
-2200
2000
11
Kg
Kg
1800 Kg
ISA-l0
I
I
STDIISA
i'
I ...
ISA 10
'I
t i
I
I'
200
I
400
I
tOO
200
-Stabilized
300
400
DISTANCES / RANGE
Figure
CONDITION
II
I.
600
I
Ii
"I
...0
.~.!
ISA 20
:j
!.
,.
800
(KmJ
1000
(NmJ
500
RANGEIN
RECOMMENDED
CRUISE
level
flight
I
N
350
82
10.2.
92-12
--
Page
8,1I
,
..-COMPLEMENTARY
(kll/h)
FLIGHT MANUAL!
(1b,,100>
.:
"\
't"
~
4
~
.u
\
50
t~
~q'
, ~
c.~
.~
I
60
O.A.T.
L\
Ib,,100>
(kg/h)
1
l
\
40 50
(OC)
tI.
1\
\
~
~
~
I'
9:'
J-c
200 ~
~
7
.~O
:
'I
.'I
~
,~
220
..;
)...
Q-
9c'
~
1\
rJ
'
\
."'" '.
.1\
.U
L' I
(1b/l\)
2eo
240
1"
'4..-
:...
1\
'!
11
~1~
~ l\
~ -l\ '"'
I\
,I
,,
(h)
fI:iI
~..o-'
'J.~
%
180 ".
'
O-.~
~
.co
140
~~'
:"'~-d
~
il
I"."
180 ~
100
II
120~
Figure 7
CONDITION
-Stabilized
level
flight
-FUEL
CONSUMPTIONENDURANCEIN CRUIS
AT MINIMUM HOURLY
FUEL CONSUMPTION
N
.35082
10.2
92-12
Page 9
--
--LOMPtEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
~
~ ~;.
8
i
O_.
~ r.
15.
DISTNa
8000
2400
1ft)
..7000
6000
II
la)
2000
0
...I
N
..
.."
5000
1500
4000
~'
1000
3000
2000
500
1000
0
0
0
0
(K8/h)
IKt)
..10
10
20
20
-40
.
t-
30
[-50
30
V~
fo6O
.;
~
rl!
~
70
~O
0
100
200
!""""."""","""",""",..""!"".","""".,.,.""","".,..,.,"",',."
0
50001STANCE
Figure
CONDITIONS
-Nonnal
takeoff
-True
wind
-Applicable
to
300
55 kts
all
-RANGE
1000
1ft)
400
1300
I.A.S.
weight
(8)
DISTANCE TO CLEAR
A SO-FOOT OBSTACLE
ON TAKEOFF
requirements
J
N
350
B2
10.2
.
92-12
---
Page 10
-cOMPtrMENTARYFLIGHT MANUAL
.j
vI ~
kt
"t~O
11581
OISTAtCE
8000
2400
11't!
II
L 7000
I~
1.1
2000
.6000
i:;
I
I
~OOO
I~
.4000
.",
1500
II
3000
1000
2000
II
1/
500
1000
0
Ii
(K./h)
(Kt)
10
=
; 10
20
..0
20
0
0
30
.;
~
~
70
40
100
200
1""1"""""""".""""."""""""""""'I"""""
0
300
(.1
1000
(ft)
400
1300
CONDITIONS
-Approach
-True
.350
65 kts I.A.S
DISTANCETO CLEAR
wind
-Applicable
A SO-FOOT OBSTACLE
to all
weight
requirements
ON LANDING
B2
10.2
92-12
Page11
.,
(OMPLEMENTARY~FLIGHT
MANUAL
SECTION 10.3
.EFFECT
OF EQUIPMENTITEMS ON PERFORMANCE
DATA
Fast cruise
Recorrmended cruise
Hourly
Equipment installed
Sand filter
.High
gear
hoist
Emergency
flotation
gear
.
.
Range
Airspeed
km/h kt
-4
+ 4 %
-5
-4
-2
% -4
-2
-1.5
+ 4 %
Range
-5
-4
-2
-1.5
-2
-1
-1
-2
-1
-1
-6
-3
-2
-6
-3
-2
-4
-2
-1.5
-4
-:2
-1.5
Protection
of the air
intake against
induction
of snow *
Float type
undercarriage
-2
fuel
co~sump
tlon
Skis
..Electric
fuel
co~sump
tlon
landing
Hourly
Airspeed
krn/t kt
R
R
R
-10
-10
-19
-10
35082
10.3
99-38
--.J
P,age 1
:
R
R
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
<-
SECTION 10.4
.PERFORMANCE
DATA WITH :
SAND FILTER INSTALLED AND
PROTECTIONOF THE AIR INTAKE AGAINST INDUCTION OF SNOW
aaainst
induction
R
of snow
R
Figures
-FUEL
CONSUMPTION -ENDURANCE
-RANGE
IN RECOMMENDEDCRUISE
1
2
3
4
IN RECOMMENDEDCRUISE
---5
6
.2
OUTSIDE AIR
TAS/CAS in fast
cruise
of figures
TEMPERATURE
Lower than
+5.C
Between +S.
and +3S.C
Higher than
+3S'C
Fig.2
Fig.2 minus
2 krn/h
Fig.6 minus
10 krn/h
R
consumption
in fast
cruise
Fig.3.
Fig.4
Fig
plus
Fig.4
Fig.4
2.5%
Fuel consumption
cruise
in
recommended
minus
3%
Fig.5 plus
2.5%
Fig.5
Fig.6 minus
2.5%
Fig.6
3%
Fig 5 minus
3%
minus
Fig.6
5%
350 B2
minus
10.4
99-38
',Page 1
~
f:
'
g
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANU~-
".
-~
35
36
38
~
40
~~~~
42
~~
~
2
4
100)
.
6
~~
..QC5
~Q
4)C5
II
,.:
...
..
~
0
..
~
-40-30-20-10
10
OAT
20
30
40
50
601500
2500
(OC)
CORRECTED
3000
3500
WEIGHT
CONDITIONS
-ALL
UP
LOAD:
WEIGHT
2250
kg
LIMITATION
(4961
Ib)
WITH
INTERNAL
CORRECTED
WEIGHT
FOR
Figure
1
.
35082
10.4
99-38
:,.~
t"I
;:
Page
;.OJ
Ca1PLEMENTARY FLIGHT
MANUAL
.-40
0 10 20
OAT (OC)
180
.100
200
.110
220
.120
240 (km/h)
.1~0(kt
)140
TAS
.0
.;0
..
~
150
ci
'
200
'
80
100
'
CAS
250 ( km/h )
I
'
120
'
140
(kt)
CONDITIONS
-STABILIZED
LEVEL FLIGHT
-SAND FILTER NOT OPERATING
OR
PROTECTION
AGAINST INDUCTION
.Figure
OF SNOW
IN
TAS -CAS
FAST
CRUISE
350 B2
10.4
99-38
.,."",;,
Page 3
~..
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAT
"'
31
33
35
:.
2
4
6
6
~
~~~
100)
.
6
,.:.;.
.::
~Q
0
0
..
tO)
0
cO
"'
-40-30-20-10
0 10 20 30 40 50601500
OAT
2500
('C)
3000
CORRECTED
3500
WEIGHT
CONDITIONS
-ALL UP WEIGHT LIMITATION
LOAD:
2250 kg (4961 Ib)
WITH
INTERNAL
CORRECTED
WEIGHT
DETERMINE
RATE
(on
facing
OF
FOR
CLIMB
page)
Figure
1
.
350 82
c(
;~
10.4
99-38
Page 4
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHTMANUAL
---10
20 30
OA T (0 C)
80
'
9'0
00'
\..
'
100
'
1101 '
120
'
13C (kt)
~t)",
..~
.<..
,,"I-
O~
\0;
:'{\Q
8g
.
0
cD
*00
150
ri,
60
'
'
80
200
'
'
100
'
250 ( km/h )
'
CAS
'
'
120
140
'
(kt)
CONDITIONS
-STABILIZED
LEVEL
FLIGHT
-SAND
FILTER
NOT OPERATING
OR
PROTECTION
AGAINST
INDUCTION
OF
SNOW
RECOMMENDED
CRUISE DATA
Figure3
R
35082
10.4
99-38
Page 5
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANU~
(kg/h)
170
16
(Ib/h)
350..
15
C1J
z
0
U
~
~~
14
13
300 >
~
12
~
0
250
:I:
110
80.
10
90
200
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1 (kg/km)
'1~0' I '1~2' I '1~4' I '1~6' I '1~8' (kg/kt)
OAT (.C)
.,
(NM)
1000
500
km)
, .I ..,
2.5
400
800
~
z
, I ' , , , I'
3
3.5
, , , I
4
(lb/NM)
CONS./SPEED
600
300
-0:
EI:
200
g
~
F"UC((%)
400
10200
.;N
~
~U)
,,:
w
CONDITIONS
-STABILIZED
LEVEL FLIGHT
-SAND
FILTER NOT OPERATING OR
PROTECTION
AGAINST INDUCTION OF SNOW
FUEL
CONSUMPTION-RANGE
IN FAST CRUISE
Figure
4
350 82
10.4
99-38
_."~
..,.
Page 6
JL
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANUAL
(kg/km)
(kg/NM)
(lb/NM
0.9
1.6
0.8
3.S
1.S
1.4
C 0.7
w
~
~ 0.6
1.3
8 O.S
0.9
1.2
1.1
2.S
0.8
0.4
60
50
..40
30
20
..
Q 10
I-
,':::
<
0 -10
-20
-30
-40
~6
::'S
w 4
()
z
< 3
II:
~2
70
'I'
80
I
.I
~
g
90
.I
'
100
.I
.I
.I
110
'
200
'I
120
.I
250
>
w
'
130
I
'
.I
140
'
.I
150
.I
'
160 (kg/h)
' I
300
HOURLY CONS.
'I
3S0
(Ib/h)
CONDITIONS
,
.-SAND
:
AGAINST
INDUCTION
FUEL
OF SNOW
CONSUMPTION-
ENDURANCE
IN
RECOMMENDED
CRUISE
.FigureS
35082
10.4
99-38
":page 7
..
'""
.
.
COMPLEMENTARY
FLIGHT MANU~1
2200
( Ib )
C)
=- 2000
4500
...
:I:
1800
..J
4000
..
1600
co
3500
~
0
,-,...
...
1400
0
2000
( m )
=-
4000
!l:
600
1000
2000
8000
10000
3000
12000
-20
WEIGHT
-2200
-10
---1800
kg
2000 kg
kg
"ffftt
~
+10
+200
~
~
I' ...I
0
100
200
I
100
300
I
400
I' ..,
200
500
I'
600
...I'
.,
700
.I'
.,
300
800
.I
400
900
I'
1000 (km)
...I'
..
500
(NM)
RANGE
ci
>'
'"
w
CONDITIONS
-STABILIZED
LEVEL FLIGHT
-SAND
FILTER NOT OPERATING OR
-PROTECTION
AGAINST INDUCTION OF SNOW
RANGE
RECOMMENDED
IN
CRUISE
Figure
6
350 82
10.4
99-38
Page 8
..AMERICAN
EUROCOPTER CORPORATION
2701 Forum Drive
Grand Prairie, Texas 75053
FOR
AEROSPATIALE MODELS AS3S0B, B1, B2, BA,
C, D, D1 HELICOPTERS
EQUIPPEDWITH
AIR CRUISERS EMERGENCY FLOATS
Registration:
Serial No.:
This supplementmustbe attachedto the DGAC Approved Rotorcraft Flight Manual, Code C,
when the helicopter is modified by the installation of the Air Cruisers EmergencyFloats in
accordancewith AerospatialeHelicopterCorporationDrawing List No. 350A-82-1157,Revision
AL, or later FAA approvedrevisions andSupplementalTypeApproval (STA) NumberSH88-18.
The information and datacontainedin this documentsupersedesor supplementsthat contained
in the basic Approved Flight Manual"Supplementin thoseareas listed herein. For Limitations,
Procedures,and Performance not contained in this document, refer to the Approved Flight
Manual and other applicable Approved Flight Manual Supplements.
Departmentof Transport (Canada)Approved:
CANADA
OEPARTI.!ENT OF TRANSPORT
AERONAUTICAL
ENGINEERING
DIVISION
~JAN 5 1994
;S
J. iamant Bouslead
Regional Airworthiness Engineer -Rolorcraft
Ontario Region
.Revision
Page 1 of 5
";
AMENDMENr
RECORD
SHEET
Amendment
No.
Date
1
Affected
Pages
AMENDED
.
Signature
94/01/05Pg.1,Company
name
change,
addmodels
AS350B1,
B2,BA,Dwg.ListRef.Change
Pg.2, Change
Format
Pg.4,(Sect.
1.7)remove
c.g.graph
Pgs.all,Change
numbering,
Pg.6deleted.
.
DOT
Approved:
June
29,1988
Revision
I: January
OS,
1994
Page
2ofS
,..
.0.0
G~NERAL(UN~PPRO.VED)
0.1
-An
-A
1.0
LI1\fiTAnONS
In addition to the specific limitations indicated below, the limitations specified in the
Basic Manual remain applicable.
1.1
1.2
This equipmentconsistsessentiallyof:
-Two
..
This supplementIS applicable when the Air Cruisers Emergency Flotation Gear is
installed on low or high skid gear.
1.3
Inflation of Floats
Maximum speedfor inflation is 136 km/h (85 mph, 74 kts) I.A.S.
1.4
.-Low
0
1.5
1.6
.DOT
Approved:June29, 1988
~ev;.ion 1: JanuaryOS,1994
Page3 of 5
1.7
The aft center of gravity limit is reducedto 3.505m (138.0 inches)with low skid
gear, and 3.472m (136.7 inches) with high skid gear.
1.8
No Change
.:t 5.20 in.
No Change
.:t 3.90 in.
NORMAL PROCEDURES
In addition to theproceduresindicatedbelow, thenormal procedurespecifiedin thebasic
manualremains applicable.
2.1
External Checks
The float closure fabric is correctly secured
-The
celsius.
2.2
system.
~
-~
-AQQroach
-In preparation for a landing, the electrical actuation system
shouldbe armed between 169 krn/h and 121 hm/h (75-105 mph, 65-91
kts).
DOT
Approved:
June
29,t988
Revision
t: laouaryO5.
1994
Page
4of5
-.
."
..
..
3.0
2.3
EMERGENCY PROCED~
In the event of an emergency necessitatingditching of the aircraft, carry out the
emergencyprocedure outlined in the basic manualas well as that detailedbelow:
Below 169 km/h (105 mph, 91 kts), arm float electrical inflation system
-Reduce
-Inflate
-If
the floats by actuatingthe firing switch on thecyclic stick (inflation time approximately 3 secondsfrom actuationof switch)
-Avoid
.
.DOT
4.0
Approved:June29, 1988
Revision1: January05,1994---~--
Page5 of 5
Group of Companies
Subject Description
Compliance
Due At
*AD T2000-340-080
(A) R2
*AD 92-078(B) R2
Daily or 8
hrs
*AD 84-064-037(B) R3
30 hrs
SB 65-00-38
100 hrs
AD 84-064-037(B) R3
100 hrs
*AD T2001-640-089
(A)
Daily or
10hrs
AD 89-155-054(B)R4
100 hrs
AD 93-090-067
100 hrs
AD 98-173-073(a)
100 hrs
AD 2002-044(A)
Daily with
underslung
load
AD2002-344-093(A)
Insp. Of Sliding Door Aft Guide Roller and Middle Rail. IAW
Alert Telex 05.00.41
(Applicable to HMZ, GSW, AVO, & FHN)
100 hrs
Initial
Group of Companies
AD1990-064 (A) R1
400 hrs
AD 84-064-037(B) R3
500 hrs
AD 85-135-042(B)
500 hrs
AD 86-097-047(B)
500 hrs
AD 86-125-48(B) R1
500 hrs or at
each
occurrence
AD 90-198-056(B)
500 hrs or at
each battery
installation
AD 2001-580085(A)R1
Tail Servo control- Eye end fitting for proper locking IAW
Alert Telex No. 05.00.37
550 hrs
"':fl/fl:,1:;,',;'.'
; ;~~
'!',r "2-:~""
~,';;;~ilij.~-
;.i~ii;;;~,*'"
~.,:I.."';)\":::"
'"." -:-
.''i.;;~:~"'j.\'"'!;;t
'Ai\~f;.~\',:;:"
')i.1~'~"..!.~~
"'i"4!;-';"~;;'
;~~'i)':'
r"
;7
OPERATIONAL
J Here is a q~ick review of how to countcycleson the Arriel engines. The pilot shouldrecordboth powerturbine
and gas turbine cycleswith eachentrymadein the flight log book.
I. Powe-rTurbine (Np)
Powerturbine cyclesarestraightforward: 1 FLIGHT = 1 CYCLE
where a flight is: One startfollowed by
One engineaccelerationto take off power followed by
Oneshutdown.
2. Gas Turbine (Ng)
Gasturbine cyclesarecalculatedusingthe following formula: Ng Cycles = Kl + K2 calculations
whereKI is the coefficientfrom table 1 colTesponding
to the maximumNg reachedduringthe flight
and K2 is the coefficientfrom table2 colTesponding
to the Minimum Ng reachedat or below 85%
during the flight.
TABLE!
Max Ng
durina fli ht
100
99
98
97
~--j
TABLE 2
Kl
Coefficient
1.0
0.9
0.8
0.7
Min Ng
K2
at or below Coefficient
85%
81-85
.05
76-80
.10
75 & lower
.15
96
95
0.6
94
93 or lower
0.55
0.5
Notes:
1. Do not include the Ng reached as part of the normal shut
down
Example:
100%
100%
%
Ng noted during flight
80% on Approach
Land
To
Start Up
___~
&
Shut Down
Kl = 1.0
K2 = 2 x 0.05
K2 = .10
Np cycles= 1.0
.~~
eurocopter
canada
~:~.~-